blob: 9e129de098a3aed2270e15df5d1b6f6e2ce79cc5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6b07bf72013-12-17 00:45:49 +01007 2013/12/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200468 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200469 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200470 - noepoll
471 - nokqueue
472 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200474 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200476 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100477 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100478 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200479 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100480 - tune.maxaccept
481 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200483 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100484 - tune.rcvbuf.client
485 - tune.rcvbuf.server
486 - tune.sndbuf.client
487 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100488 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100489 - tune.ssl.lifetime
490 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100491 - tune.zlib.memlevel
492 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494 * Debugging
495 - debug
496 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200497
498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004993.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500------------------------------------
501
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200502ca-base <dir>
503 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200504 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
505 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200506
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507chroot <jail dir>
508 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
509 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
510 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
511 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
512 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
513 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100514
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100515cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
516 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
517 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
518 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
519 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
520 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
521 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
522 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
523 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
524 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
525 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
526 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
527 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
528 they overlap.
529
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200530crt-base <dir>
531 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
532 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
533 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
534
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200535daemon
536 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
537 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
538 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
539
540gid <number>
541 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
542 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
543 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100544 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
545 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548group <group name>
549 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
550 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100551
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200552log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
554 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100555 configured with "log global".
556
557 <address> can be one of:
558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100559 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100560 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
561 port).
562
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100563 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
564 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
565 port).
566
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100567 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
568 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
569 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
570 writeable).
571
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100572 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
573 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
574 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
575 in Bourne shell.
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578
579 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
580 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
581 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
582
583 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200584 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
585 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
586 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
587 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
588 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
589 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200591 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100593log-send-hostname [<string>]
594 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
595 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
596 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
597 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
598 the logs.
599
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000600log-tag <string>
601 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
602 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
603 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
604 running on the same host.
605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606nbproc <number>
607 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
608 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
609 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
610 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
611 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
612
613pidfile <pidfile>
614 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
615 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
616 starting the process. See also "daemon".
617
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100618stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200619 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
620 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
621 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
622 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
623 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
624 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
625 the number of processes used.
626
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200627stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
628 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
629 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
630 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
631 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200632
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200633 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
634 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
635 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200636
637stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
638 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
639 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100640 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200641
642stats maxconn <connections>
643 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
644 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646uid <number>
647 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
648 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
649 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
650 one. See also "gid" and "user".
651
652ulimit-n <number>
653 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
654 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
655 option.
656
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100657unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
658 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
659
660 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
661 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
662 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
663 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
664 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
665 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
666 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
667 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
668 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
669 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671user <user name>
672 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
673 See also "uid" and "group".
674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200675node <name>
676 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
677
678 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
679 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
680 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
681 traffic.
682
683description <text>
684 Add a text that describes the instance.
685
686 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
687 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
688 "<" and ">" characters.
689
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692-----------------------
693
694maxconn <number>
695 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
696 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
697 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
698 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
699
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200700maxconnrate <number>
701 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
702 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
703 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
704 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
705 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
706 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
707 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
708 fairness.
709
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100710maxcomprate <number>
711 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
712 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
713 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
714 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
715 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
716 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
717 default value.
718
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100719maxcompcpuusage <number>
720 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
721 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
722 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
723 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
724 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
725 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
726 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
727 process down and from introducing high latencies.
728
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100729maxpipes <number>
730 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
731 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
732 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
733 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
734 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
735 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
736
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200737maxsessrate <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
739 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
740 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
741 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
742 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
743 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
744 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
745 fairness.
746
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200747maxsslconn <number>
748 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
749 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
750 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
751 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
752 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
753 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
754 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
755
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100756maxzlibmem <number>
757 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
758 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
759 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100760 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
761 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
762 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764noepoll
765 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
766 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
769nokqueue
770 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
771 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
772 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
773
774nopoll
775 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
776 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100777 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100778 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100780nosplice
781 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
782 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
783 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100784 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100785 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
786 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
787 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
788 "option splice-response".
789
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200790spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900791 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
792 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
793 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
794 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
795 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
796 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200797
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200798tune.bufsize <number>
799 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
800 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
801 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
802 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
803 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
804 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
805 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
806 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400807 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
808 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
809 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200810
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200811tune.chksize <number>
812 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
813 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
814 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
815 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
816 checks whenever possible.
817
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100818tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
819 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
820 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
821 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
822 this value. The default value is 1.
823
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100824tune.http.cookielen <number>
825 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
826 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
827 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
828 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
829 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
830 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
831 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
832 to change this value.
833
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200834tune.http.maxhdr <number>
835 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
836 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
837 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
838 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
839 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
840 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
841 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
842 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
843 limit too high.
844
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100845tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100846 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
847 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
848 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
849 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
850 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
851 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
852 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
853 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
854 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
855 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100856
857tune.maxpollevents <number>
858 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
859 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
860 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
861 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
862 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
863
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200864tune.maxrewrite <number>
865 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
866 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
867 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
868 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
869 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
870 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
871 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
872 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
873 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
874 bufsize.
875
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200876tune.pipesize <number>
877 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
878 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
879 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
880 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
881 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
882 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
883
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100884tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
885tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
886 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
887 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
888 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
889 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
890 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
891 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
892 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
893
894tune.sndbuf.client <number>
895tune.sndbuf.server <number>
896 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
897 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
898 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
899 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
900 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
901 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
902 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
903 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
904 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
905 notifying haproxy again.
906
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100907tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100908 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
909 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
910 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
911 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
912 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
913 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
914 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
915 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
916 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100917 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
918 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100919
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100920tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
921 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
922 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
923 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
924 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
925 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
926 being used for too long.
927
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100928tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
929 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
930 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
931 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
932 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
933 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
934 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
935 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
936 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
937 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
938 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
939 best value.
940
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100941tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
942 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
943 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
944 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
945 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
946 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
947
948tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
949 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
950 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
951 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
952 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009543.3. Debugging
955--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956
957debug
958 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
959 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
960 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
961 system startup.
962
963quiet
964 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
965 line argument "-q".
966
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009683.4. Userlists
969--------------
970It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
971http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
972it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
973
974userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100975 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100976 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
977
978group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100979 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100980 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
981 proceeded by "users" keyword.
982
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
984 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100985 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
986 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100987 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
988 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
990 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
991
992
993 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100994 userlist L1
995 group G1 users tiger,scott
996 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100998 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
999 user scott insecure-password elgato
1000 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001001
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001002 userlist L2
1003 group G1
1004 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001005
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001006 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1007 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1008 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001009
1010 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001011
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001012
10133.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001014----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001015It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1016haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1017pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1018identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1019or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1020Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1021known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1022the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1023process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1024during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1025tables.
1026
1027peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001028 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001029 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1030
1031peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1032 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1033 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1034 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1035 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1036 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1037 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1038
1039 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1040 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1041
1042 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1043 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1044 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1045 across all peers.
1046
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001047 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1048 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1049 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1050
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001051 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001052 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001053 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1054 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1055 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001056
1057 backend mybackend
1058 mode tcp
1059 balance roundrobin
1060 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1061 stick on src
1062
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001063 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1064 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001065
1066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010674. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1071 - defaults <name>
1072 - frontend <name>
1073 - backend <name>
1074 - listen <name>
1075
1076A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1077its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1078section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080
1081A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1082connections.
1083
1084A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1085to forward incoming connections.
1086
1087A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1088parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001090All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1091'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1092case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1093
1094Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1095logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1096proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1097However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1098name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1099
1100Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1101and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001102bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001103protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1104modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1105arbitrary criteria.
1106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1109--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001111The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1112limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1113they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1114limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001115marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001116option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001117and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1118with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1119specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001122 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1123------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1124acl - X X X
1125appsession - - X X
1126backlog X X X -
1127balance X - X X
1128bind - X X -
1129bind-process X X X X
1130block - X X X
1131capture cookie - X X -
1132capture request header - X X -
1133capture response header - X X -
1134clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001135compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001136contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1137cookie X - X X
1138default-server X - X X
1139default_backend X X X -
1140description - X X X
1141disabled X X X X
1142dispatch - - X X
1143enabled X X X X
1144errorfile X X X X
1145errorloc X X X X
1146errorloc302 X X X X
1147-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1148errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001149force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150fullconn X - X X
1151grace X X X X
1152hash-type X - X X
1153http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001154http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001155http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001156http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001157http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001158tcp-check expect - - X X
1159tcp-check send - - X X
1160tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001161http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001162id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001163ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001164log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001165maxconn X X X -
1166mode X X X X
1167monitor fail - X X -
1168monitor-net X X X -
1169monitor-uri X X X -
1170option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1171option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1172option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1173option allbackups (*) X - X X
1174option checkcache (*) X - X X
1175option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1176option contstats (*) X X X -
1177option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1178option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1179option forceclose (*) X X X X
1180-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1181option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001182option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001183option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001184option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001185option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1186option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1187option httpchk X - X X
1188option httpclose (*) X X X X
1189option httplog X X X X
1190option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001191option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001192option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001193option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1194option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1195option logasap (*) X X X -
1196option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001197option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001198option nolinger (*) X X X X
1199option originalto X X X X
1200option persist (*) X - X X
1201option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001202option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001203option smtpchk X - X X
1204option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1205option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1206option splice-request (*) X X X X
1207option splice-response (*) X X X X
1208option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1209option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1210-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001211option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001212option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1213option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1214option tcpka X X X X
1215option tcplog X X X X
1216option transparent (*) X - X X
1217persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1218rate-limit sessions X X X -
1219redirect - X X X
1220redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1221redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1222reqadd - X X X
1223reqallow - X X X
1224reqdel - X X X
1225reqdeny - X X X
1226reqiallow - X X X
1227reqidel - X X X
1228reqideny - X X X
1229reqipass - X X X
1230reqirep - X X X
1231reqisetbe - X X X
1232reqitarpit - X X X
1233reqpass - X X X
1234reqrep - X X X
1235-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1236reqsetbe - X X X
1237reqtarpit - X X X
1238retries X - X X
1239rspadd - X X X
1240rspdel - X X X
1241rspdeny - X X X
1242rspidel - X X X
1243rspideny - X X X
1244rspirep - X X X
1245rsprep - X X X
1246server - - X X
1247source X - X X
1248srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001249stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250stats auth X - X X
1251stats enable X - X X
1252stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001253stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001254stats realm X - X X
1255stats refresh X - X X
1256stats scope X - X X
1257stats show-desc X - X X
1258stats show-legends X - X X
1259stats show-node X - X X
1260stats uri X - X X
1261-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1262stick match - - X X
1263stick on - - X X
1264stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001265stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001266stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001267tcp-request connection - X X -
1268tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001269tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001270tcp-response content - - X X
1271tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272timeout check X - X X
1273timeout client X X X -
1274timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1275timeout connect X - X X
1276timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1277timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1278timeout http-request X X X X
1279timeout queue X - X X
1280timeout server X - X X
1281timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1282timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001283timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001284transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001285unique-id-format X X X -
1286unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001287use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001288use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001289------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1290 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001291
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1294---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001295
1296This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1297
1298
1299acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1300 Declare or complete an access list.
1301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1302 no | yes | yes | yes
1303 Example:
1304 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1305 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1306 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001308 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309
1310
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001311appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1312 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1315 no | no | yes | yes
1316 Arguments :
1317 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1318 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1319
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001320 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001321 checked in each cookie value.
1322
1323 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1324 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1325 milliseconds.
1326
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001327 request-learn
1328 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1329 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1330 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1331 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1332 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1333 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1334
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001335 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1336 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1337 data following this prefix.
1338
1339 Example :
1340 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1341
1342 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1343 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1344
1345 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1346 2 modes are currently supported :
1347 - path-parameters :
1348 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1349 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1350 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1351 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1352 - query-string :
1353 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1354 query string.
1355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001356 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1357 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1358 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1359 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001360 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1361 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1362 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001363 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1364 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1365
1366 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1367
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001368 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1369 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1370 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001372 Example :
1373 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1374
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001375 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1376 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001377
1378
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001379backlog <conns>
1380 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1382 yes | yes | yes | no
1383 Arguments :
1384 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1385 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001386 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001387
1388 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1389 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1390 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1391 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1392 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1393 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1394 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1395 backlog parameter.
1396
1397 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1398 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1399 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1400
1401 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1402
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001405balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001406 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1408 yes | no | yes | yes
1409 Arguments :
1410 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1411 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1412 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1413 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1414
1415 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1416 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1417 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1418 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001419 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001420 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001421 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1422 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1423 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1424 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1425 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1426 it, so that you don't worry.
1427
1428 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1429 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1430 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1431 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1432 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1433 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1434 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1435 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001436
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001437 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1438 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1439 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1440 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1441 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1442 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1443 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1444 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1445
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001446 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1447 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1448 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1449 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001450 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001451 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1452 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1453 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1454 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1455 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001456 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1457 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1458 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1459 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1460 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1461 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001463 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1464 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1465 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1466 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1467 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1468 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1469 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1470 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001471 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001472 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001473 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1474 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1475 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001477 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1478 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1479 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1480 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1481 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1482 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1483 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1484 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1485 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1486 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1487 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1488 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001490 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001491 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1492 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1493 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1494 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1495 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1496 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1497 URIs start with a leading "/".
1498
1499 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1500 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1501 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1502 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001504 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001505 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1506
1507 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001508 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1509 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1510 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1511 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1512 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1513 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1514 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1515 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1516 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1517 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1518 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1519 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1520 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1521 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1522 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1523 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1524 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1525 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1526 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001527
1528 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1529 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1530 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1531 server will receive the request.
1532
1533 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1534 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1535 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1536 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1537 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001538 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1539 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1540 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001542 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1543 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1544 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1545 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1546 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001548 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001549 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1550 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1551 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1552
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001553 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1554 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1555 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1556
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001557 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001558 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001559 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1560 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1561 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1562 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1563 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1564 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001565 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001566 used instead.
1567
1568 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1569 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1570 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1571 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1572
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001573 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1574 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1575 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1576
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001577 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001579 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001580 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1581 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001582
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001583 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001584 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001585
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001586 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1587 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1588 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001589
1590 Examples :
1591 balance roundrobin
1592 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001593 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001594 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1595 balance hdr(host)
1596 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001597
1598 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1599 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001601 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001602 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1603 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1604 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1605 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1606
1607 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1608 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1609 defaults to 16 kB.
1610
1611 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1612 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1613
1614 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1615 Round Robin.
1616
1617 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1618 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1619 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1620 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1621
1622 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1623
1624 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001625 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001626 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1627 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1628 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001629
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001630 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1631 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632
1633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001634bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1635bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1638 no | yes | yes | no
1639 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001640 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1641 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1642 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1643 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001644 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001645 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1646 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1647 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1648 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1649 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1650 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1651 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001652 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1653 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1654 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001655 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1656 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1657 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1658 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001659
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001660 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1661 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001662 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1663 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1664 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001665 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1666 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1667 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1668 the range.
1669
1670 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1671 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1672 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1673 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1674 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1675 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1676 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001677 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001678 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001680 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1681 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1682 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1683 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1684 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1685 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1686 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1687 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1688
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001689 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1690 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1691 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1692 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1695 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1696 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1697 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1698 in a frontend.
1699
1700 Example :
1701 listen http_proxy
1702 bind :80,:443
1703 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001704 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001705
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001706 listen http_https_proxy
1707 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001708 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001709
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001710 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1711 bind ipv6@:80
1712 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1713 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1714
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001715 listen external_bind_app1
1716 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1717
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001718 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001719 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720
1721
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001722bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001723 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1725 yes | yes | yes | yes
1726 Arguments :
1727 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1728 may be used to override a default value.
1729
1730 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1731 option may be combined with other numbers.
1732
1733 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1734 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1735 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1736 missing from all processes.
1737
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001738 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1739 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1740 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1741 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1742 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001743
1744 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1745 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1746 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1747 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1748 and 'even' instances.
1749
1750 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1751 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1752 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1753 32.
1754
1755 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1756 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1757
1758 Example :
1759 listen app_ip1
1760 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001761 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001762
1763 listen app_ip2
1764 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001765 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001766
1767 listen management
1768 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001769 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001770
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001771 listen management
1772 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1773 bind-process 1-4
1774
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001775 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1776
1777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778block { if | unless } <condition>
1779 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1781 no | yes | yes | yes
1782
1783 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1784 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001786 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1788 "block" statements per instance.
1789
1790 Example:
1791 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1792 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1793 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1794 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001796 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
1798
1799capture cookie <name> len <length>
1800 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1802 no | yes | yes | no
1803 Arguments :
1804 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1805 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1806 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1807 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1808 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1809
1810 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1811 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1812 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1813 right if it exceeds <length>.
1814
1815 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1816 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1817 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1818 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1819
1820 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1821 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1822 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1823
1824 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1825 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1826 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001827 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1828 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1829 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
1831 Example:
1832 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1833
1834 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001835 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
1837
1838capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001839 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 no | yes | yes | no
1842 Arguments :
1843 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001844 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1846 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1847 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1848
1849 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1850 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1851 it exceeds <length>.
1852
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001853 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1855 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001856 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1857 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1858 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1859 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001860 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001861 environments to find where the request came from.
1862
1863 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1864 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1865 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1866 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001868 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1869 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1870 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1871 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1872 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873
1874 Example:
1875 capture request header Host len 15
1876 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1877 capture request header Referrer len 15
1878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001879 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880 about logging.
1881
1882
1883capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001884 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1886 no | yes | yes | no
1887 Arguments :
1888 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001889 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1891 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1892 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1893
1894 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1895 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1896 it exceeds <length>.
1897
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001898 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1900 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1901 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001902 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1903 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1904 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1905 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001907 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1908 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1909 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1910 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1911 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912
1913 Example:
1914 capture response header Content-length len 9
1915 capture response header Location len 15
1916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001917 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 about logging.
1919
1920
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001921clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001922 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1924 yes | yes | yes | no
1925 Arguments :
1926 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1928 as explained at the top of this document.
1929
1930 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1931 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1932 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1933 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1934 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1935 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1936 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1937 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001938 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1940 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1941
1942 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1943 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1944 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1945 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1946 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1947 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1948
1949 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1950 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1951
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001952 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1953 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001955compression algo <algorithm> ...
1956compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001957compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001958 Enable HTTP compression.
1959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1960 yes | yes | yes | yes
1961 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001962 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1963 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1964 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1965
1966 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001967 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001968 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1969 data.
1970
1971 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1972 support for zlib was built in.
1973
1974 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1975 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1976 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1977 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1978 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1979 in.
1980
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001981 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001982 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001983 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1984 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1985 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1986 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1987 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001988
1989 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1990 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1991 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1992 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1993 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001994 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1995 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1996 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1997 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1998 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1999 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002000
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002001 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002002 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2003 "Accept-Encoding" header
2004 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002005 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002006 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2007 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002008 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2009 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2010 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2011 "multipart"
2012 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2013 header
2014 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2015 and later
2016 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2017 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002018
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002019 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2020 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002021
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002022 Examples :
2023 compression algo gzip
2024 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002026contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2029 yes | no | yes | yes
2030 Arguments :
2031 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2032 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2033 as explained at the top of this document.
2034
2035 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002036 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002037 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2039 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2040 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2041 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2042
2043 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2044 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2045 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2046 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2047 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2048 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2049
2050 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2051 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2052 instead.
2053
2054 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2055 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2056
2057
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002058cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002059 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2060 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2063 yes | no | yes | yes
2064 Arguments :
2065 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2066 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2067 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2068 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2069 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2070 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2071 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2072 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2073 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2074
2075 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2076 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2077 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2078 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2079 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2080 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2081 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2082 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2083 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2084 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2085 "insert" and "prefix".
2086
2087 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002088 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002089
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002090 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002091 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2092 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2093 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2094 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2095 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2096 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2097 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2098 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2099 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2100 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101
2102 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2103 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2104 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2105 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2106 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2107 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2108 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2109 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2110 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2111 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002112 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2113 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2114 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002116 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2117 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2118 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002119 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2120 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2121 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2122 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002123 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2124 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2125 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
2127 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2128 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2129 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2130 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2131 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2132 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2133 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2134 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2135 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2136
2137 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2138 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2139 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2140 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2141 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2142 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2143 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2144 persistence cookie in the cache.
2145 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2146
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002147 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2148 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2149 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2150 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2151 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2152 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2153 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2154 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2155 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2156 they logout.
2157
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002158 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2159 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2160 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2161 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2162
2163 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2164 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2165 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2166 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2167 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2168 this attribute.
2169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002170 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002171 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002172 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2173 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2174 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2175 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2176 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2177 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002178
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002179 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2180 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2181 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2182 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2183 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2184 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2185 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2186 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2187 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2188 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2189 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2190 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2191 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2192 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2193 the site.
2194
2195 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2196 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2197 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2198 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2199 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2200 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2201 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2202 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2203 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2204 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2205 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2206 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2207 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2208 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2209 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2210 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2211
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002212 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2213 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2214 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2215 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217 Examples :
2218 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2219 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2220 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002221 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002223 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002224 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002227default-server [param*]
2228 Change default options for a server in a backend
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2230 yes | no | yes | yes
2231 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002232 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2233 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2234 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2235 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002236
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002237 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002238 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2239
2240 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243default_backend <backend>
2244 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2246 yes | yes | yes | no
2247 Arguments :
2248 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2249
2250 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2251 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2252 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2253 will catch all undetermined requests.
2254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 Example :
2256
2257 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2258 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2259 default_backend dynamic
2260
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002261 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002264description <string>
2265 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2267 no | yes | yes | yes
2268 Arguments : string
2269
2270 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2271 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2272 it describes.
2273 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2274
2275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276disabled
2277 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2279 yes | yes | yes | yes
2280 Arguments : none
2281
2282 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2283 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2284 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2285 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2286 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2287 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2288 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2289
2290 See also : "enabled"
2291
2292
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002293dispatch <address>:<port>
2294 Set a default server address
2295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2296 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002297 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002298
2299 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2300 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2301 during start-up.
2302
2303 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2304 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2305 possible with normal servers.
2306
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002307 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002308 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2309 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2310 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2311 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2312
2313 See also : "server"
2314
2315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002316enabled
2317 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 yes | yes | yes | yes
2320 Arguments : none
2321
2322 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2323 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2324
2325 See also : "disabled"
2326
2327
2328errorfile <code> <file>
2329 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2331 yes | yes | yes | yes
2332 Arguments :
2333 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002334 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335
2336 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002337 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002338 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002339 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2340 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341
2342 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2343 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2344 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2345
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002346 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2349 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2350 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2351 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2352
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002353 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2354 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2355 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2356 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2357 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2358 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002360 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2361 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2362 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002363 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2365
2366 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2367
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002368 Example :
2369 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2370 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2371 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2372
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002373
2374errorloc <code> <url>
2375errorloc302 <code> <url>
2376 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2378 yes | yes | yes | yes
2379 Arguments :
2380 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002381 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002382
2383 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2384 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2385 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2386 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2387 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2388
2389 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2390 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2391 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2392
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002393 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2396 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2397 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2398 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2399 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2400 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2401 request.
2402
2403 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2404
2405
2406errorloc303 <code> <url>
2407 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2409 yes | yes | yes | yes
2410 Arguments :
2411 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2412 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2413
2414 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2415 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2416 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2417 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2418 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2419
2420 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2421 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2422 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2423
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002424 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2425
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002426 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2427 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2428 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2429 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002430 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002431
2432 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2433
2434
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002435force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2436 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2437 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2438 no | yes | yes | yes
2439
2440 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2441 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2442 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2443 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2444 marked down for maintenance operations.
2445
2446 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2447 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2448 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2449 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2450 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2451 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2452 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2453 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2454 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2455
2456 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2457 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2458 is used.
2459
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002460 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002461 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002462
2463
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002464fullconn <conns>
2465 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2467 yes | no | yes | yes
2468 Arguments :
2469 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2470 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2471
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002472 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002473 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002474 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002475 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2476 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2477 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2478 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2479 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002480 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002481
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002482 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2483 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2484 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002486 Example :
2487 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2488 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2489 # connections.
2490 backend dynamic
2491 fullconn 10000
2492 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2493 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2494
2495 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2496
2497
2498grace <time>
2499 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002501 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002502 Arguments :
2503 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2504 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2505 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2506
2507 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2508 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002509 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002510 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2511
2512 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2513 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2514 simplify it.
2515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002517hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002518 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2520 yes | no | yes | yes
2521 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002522 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2523 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002524
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002525 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2526 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2527 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2528 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2529 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2530 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2531 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2532 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2533 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2534 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002535
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002536 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2537 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2538 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2539 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2540 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2541 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2542 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2543 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2544 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2545 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2546 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2547 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2548 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002549 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2550 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002551
2552 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2553
2554 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2555 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2556 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2557 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002558 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2559 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2560 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002561
2562 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2563 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002564 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2565 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2566 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2567 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2568
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002569 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2570 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2571 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2572 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2573 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2574 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2575 parameter.
2576
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002577 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2578
2579 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2580 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2581 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2582 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2583 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2584 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2585 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2586 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2587 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2588 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2589 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2590 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002591
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002592 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2593 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2594 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002595
2596 See also : "balance", "server"
2597
2598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599http-check disable-on-404
2600 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603 Arguments : none
2604
2605 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2606 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2607 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2608 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2609 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2610 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2611 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2612 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002613 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2614 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2615 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2616
2617 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2618
2619
2620http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002621 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002623 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002624 Arguments :
2625 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2626 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002627 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002628 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2629 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2630 details on the supported keywords.
2631
2632 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2633 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2634 with the usual backslash ('\').
2635
2636 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2637 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2638 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2639 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2640 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2641
2642 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002643 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002644 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2645 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2646 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2647
2648 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002649 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002650 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2651 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2652 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2653 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2654
2655 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002656 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002657 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2658 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2659 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2660 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2661 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2662 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2663 trace).
2664
2665 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002666 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002667 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2668 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2669 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2670 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2671 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2672 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2673
2674 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2675 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2676 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2677 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2678 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2679 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2680 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2681 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2682
2683 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2684 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2685
2686 Examples :
2687 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002688 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002689
2690 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002691 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002692
2693 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002694 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002695
2696 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002697 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002699 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002700
2701
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002702http-check send-state
2703 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2705 yes | no | yes | yes
2706 Arguments : none
2707
2708 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2709 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2710 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2711 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2712 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2713
2714 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2715 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2716 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2717 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2718 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2719 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2720 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2721 checked in multiple backends.
2722
2723 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2724 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2725
2726 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2727 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2728 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2729 one fails.
2730
2731 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2732 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2733 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2734
2735 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2736 server's queue.
2737
2738 Example of a header received by the application server :
2739 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2740 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2741
2742 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2743
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002744http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002745 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002746 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2747 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002748 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002749 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2750
2751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2752 no | yes | yes | yes
2753
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002754 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2755 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2756 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2757 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2758 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002759
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002760 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2761 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2762 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2763
2764 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2765 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2766 are evaluated.
2767
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002768 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2769 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2770 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2771 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2772 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2773 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2774 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2775 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2776 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2777 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2778 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2779
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002780 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2781 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2782 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2783 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2784 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2785
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002786 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2787 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2788 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002789 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2790 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002791
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002792 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2793 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2794 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2795 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2796 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2797 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2798 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2799 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2800
2801 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2802 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2803 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2804 external users.
2805
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002806 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2807 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2808 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2809 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2810 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2811 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2812 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2813 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2814
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002815 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2816 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2817 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2818 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2819 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2820 another equipment.
2821
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002822 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2823 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2824 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2825 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2826 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2827 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2828 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2829 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2830
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002831 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2832 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2833 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2834 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2835 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2836 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2837 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2838 admin privileges.
2839
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002840 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2841
2842 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2843 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2844 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2845 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002846
2847 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002848 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2849 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2850 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002851
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002852 http-request allow if nagios
2853 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2854 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2855 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002856
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002857 Example:
2858 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002859 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002860
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002861 Example:
2862 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2863 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2864 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2865 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2866 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2867 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2868 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2869 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2870 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2871
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002872 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2873 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002874
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002875http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002876 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002877 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2878 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002879 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2880
2881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 no | yes | yes | yes
2883
2884 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2885 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2886 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2887 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2888 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2889 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2890
2891 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2892 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2893 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2894 current section.
2895
2896 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2897 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2898 rules are evaluated.
2899
2900 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2901 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2902 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2903 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2904 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2905 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2906 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2907
2908 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2909 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2910 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2911 external users.
2912
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002913 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2914 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2915 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2916 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2917 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2918 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2919 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2920 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2921
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002922 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2923 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2924 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2925 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2926 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2927 another equipment.
2928
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002929 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2930 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2931 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2932 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2933 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2934 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2935 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2936 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2937
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002938 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2939 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2940 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2941 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2942 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2943 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2944 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2945 admin privileges.
2946
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002947 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2948
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002949 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002950 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2951 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2952 rules.
2953
2954 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2955 ACL usage.
2956
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002957
2958tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2959 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 no | no | yes | yes
2962
2963 Arguments :
2964 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2965 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2966 binary.
2967 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2968 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2969 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2970
2971 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2972 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2973 with the usual backslash ('\').
2974 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2975 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2976 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2977 used upper or lower case.
2978
2979
2980 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
2981
2982 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
2983 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2984 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
2985 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2986 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2987 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
2988 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
2989 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
2990
2991 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
2992 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2993 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
2994 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2995 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
2996 expression.
2997
2998 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
2999 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3000 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3001 this exact hexadecimal string.
3002 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3003
3004 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3005 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3006 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3007 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3008 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3009 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3010 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3011 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3012 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3013 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3014 the null character.
3015
3016 Examples :
3017 # perform a POP check
3018 option tcp-check
3019 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3020
3021 # perform an IMAP check
3022 option tcp-check
3023 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3024
3025 # look for the redis master server
3026 option tcp-check
3027 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3028 tcp-check expect +PONG
3029 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3030 tcp-check expect string role:master
3031 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3032 tcp-check expect string +OK
3033
3034
3035 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3036 tune.chksize
3037
3038
3039tcp-check send <data>
3040 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3042 no | no | yes | yes
3043
3044 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3045 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3046
3047 Examples :
3048 # look for the redis master server
3049 option tcp-check
3050 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3051 tcp-check expect string role:master
3052
3053 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3054 tune.chksize
3055
3056
3057tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3058 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3059 tcp health check
3060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3061 no | no | yes | yes
3062
3063 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3064 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3065 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3066 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3067 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3068 hexadecimal string.
3069 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3070
3071 Examples :
3072 # redis check in binary
3073 option tcp-check
3074 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3075 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3076
3077
3078 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3079 tune.chksize
3080
3081
3082
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003083http-send-name-header [<header>]
3084 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3085
3086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 yes | no | yes | yes
3088
3089 Arguments :
3090
3091 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3092
3093 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3094 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3095 is added with the header string proved.
3096
3097 See also : "server"
3098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003099id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003100 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3102 no | yes | yes | yes
3103 Arguments : none
3104
3105 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3106 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3107 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003108
3109
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003110ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3111 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3113 no | yes | yes | yes
3114
3115 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3116 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3117 and running).
3118
3119 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3120 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3121 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3122 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3123 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3124
3125 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3126 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3127
3128 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3129 "unless" condition is met.
3130
3131 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3132
3133
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003134log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003135log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003136no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003137 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3139 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003140
3141 Prefix :
3142 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3143 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3144 prefix does not allow arguments.
3145
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003146 Arguments :
3147 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3148 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3149 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3150 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3151 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3152 parameter.
3153
3154 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3155 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3156
3157 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3158 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3159 standard syslog port).
3160
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003161 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3162 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3163 standard syslog port).
3164
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003165 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3166 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3167 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3168 appropriately writeable).
3169
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003170 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3171 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3172 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3173 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003175 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3176
3177 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3178 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3179 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3180
3181 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3182 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3183 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003184 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3185 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3186 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3187 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3188 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003189
3190 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3191
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003192 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3193 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3194 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003195
3196 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3197 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3198 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3199 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3200
3201 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3202 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003203
3204 Example :
3205 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003206 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3207 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003208 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003210
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003211log-format <string>
3212 Allows you to custom a log line.
3213
3214 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216
3217maxconn <conns>
3218 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3220 yes | yes | yes | no
3221 Arguments :
3222 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3223 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3224 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3225 closes.
3226
3227 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3228 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3229 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3230 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3231 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3232 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3233 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3234 properly tuned.
3235
3236 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3237 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3238 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3239
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003240 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003242 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3243
3244
3245mode { tcp|http|health }
3246 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3248 yes | yes | yes | yes
3249 Arguments :
3250 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3251 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3252 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3253 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3254
3255 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3256 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3257 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3258 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3259 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3260
3261 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003262 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3263 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3264 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3265 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3266 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3267 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3268 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003269
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003270 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3271 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3272 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003273
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003274 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003275 defaults http_instances
3276 mode http
3277
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003278 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003281monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003282 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3284 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285 Arguments :
3286 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3287 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003288 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3290 backend and its backup.
3291
3292 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3293 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3294 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3295 servers in a list of backends.
3296
3297 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3298 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3299 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3300 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3301 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3302 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3303 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003304 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3305 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
3307 Example:
3308 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003309 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3311 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3312 monitor-uri /site_alive
3313 monitor fail if site_dead
3314
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003315 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003316
3317
3318monitor-net <source>
3319 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | yes | yes | no
3322 Arguments :
3323 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3324 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3325 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3326 followed by a mask.
3327
3328 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3329 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003330 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003331 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3332
3333 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3334 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3335 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3336 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003337 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3338 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3339 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003340
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003341 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3342 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3343 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3344 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3345 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3346 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003347
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003348 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3349 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003350
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003351 Example :
3352 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3353 frontend www
3354 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3355
3356 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3357
3358
3359monitor-uri <uri>
3360 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 yes | yes | yes | no
3363 Arguments :
3364 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3365 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3366
3367 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3368 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3369 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3370 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3371 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3372 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3373 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3374 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3375
3376 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3377 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3378 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3379 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3380 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3381 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3382
3383 Example :
3384 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3385 frontend www
3386 mode http
3387 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3388
3389 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003391
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003392option abortonclose
3393no option abortonclose
3394 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3396 yes | no | yes | yes
3397 Arguments : none
3398
3399 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3400 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3401 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3402 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003403 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003404 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3405 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3406 encountered while delivering the response.
3407
3408 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3409 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3410 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3411 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3412 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3413 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003414 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003415 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003416 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003417 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3418 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3419 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3420
3421 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3422 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3423 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3424 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3425 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3426 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3427 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3428 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003429 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003430
3431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3433
3434 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3435
3436
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003437option accept-invalid-http-request
3438no option accept-invalid-http-request
3439 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | yes | yes | no
3442 Arguments : none
3443
3444 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3445 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3446 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3447 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3448 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3449 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3450 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3451 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003452 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3453 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3454 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3455 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3456 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3457 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003458
3459 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3460 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3461 been confirmed.
3462
3463 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3464 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003465 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3466 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003467 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3468
3469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3471
3472 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3473 stats socket.
3474
3475
3476option accept-invalid-http-response
3477no option accept-invalid-http-response
3478 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3480 yes | no | yes | yes
3481 Arguments : none
3482
3483 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3484 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3485 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3486 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3487 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3488 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3489 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3490 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3491 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3492
3493 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3494 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3495 been confirmed.
3496
3497 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3498 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3499 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3500 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3501
3502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3504
3505 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3506 stats socket.
3507
3508
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003509option allbackups
3510no option allbackups
3511 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | no | yes | yes
3514 Arguments : none
3515
3516 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3517 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3518 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3519 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3520 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3521 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3522 order between the backup servers anymore.
3523
3524 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3525 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3526
3527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3529
3530
3531option checkcache
3532no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003533 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | no | yes | yes
3536 Arguments : none
3537
3538 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3539 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003540 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003541 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3542 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003543 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003544
3545 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003546 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003547 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003548 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3549 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003550 to the client are :
3551 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003552 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003553 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3555 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3556 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3557 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3558 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3559 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3560 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3561 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3562 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3563 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3564 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3565
3566 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003567 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003568 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003569 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003570 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3571
3572 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3573 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003574 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003575 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3576
3577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3579
3580
3581option clitcpka
3582no option clitcpka
3583 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | no
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3589 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3590 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3591 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3592
3593 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3594 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3595 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3596 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3597
3598 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3599 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3600 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3601 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3602 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3603
3604 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3605
3606 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3607 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3608 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3609
3610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3612
3613 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3614
3615
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616option contstats
3617 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | yes | yes | no
3620 Arguments : none
3621
3622 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3623 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3624 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3625 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3626 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3627 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3628 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3629
3630
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003631option dontlog-normal
3632no option dontlog-normal
3633 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | yes | yes | no
3636 Arguments : none
3637
3638 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3639 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3640 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3641 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3642 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3643 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3644 logged.
3645
3646 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3647 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3648 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003650 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003651 logging.
3652
3653
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003654option dontlognull
3655no option dontlognull
3656 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 yes | yes | yes | no
3659 Arguments : none
3660
3661 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3662 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3663 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3664 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3665 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3666 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3667 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3668
3669 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3670 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3671 would not be logged.
3672
3673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003676 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003677
3678
3679option forceclose
3680no option forceclose
3681 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003683 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684 Arguments : none
3685
3686 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3687 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3688 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3689 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3690 global session times in the logs.
3691
3692 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003693 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003694 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3695 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3696 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3697 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003699 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3700 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3701 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3702
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3705
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003706 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707
3708
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003709option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003710 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3712 yes | yes | yes | yes
3713 Arguments :
3714 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3715 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003716 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003717 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003718
3719 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3720 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3721 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3722 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3723 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3724 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3725 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003726 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3727 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3728 possible that the client has already brought one.
3729
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003730 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003731 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003732 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3733 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003734 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3735 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003736
3737 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3738 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3739 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3740 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3741 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3742 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3743 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3744
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003745 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3746 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3747 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3748 are under the control of the end-user.
3749
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003750 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003751 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3752 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003753 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3754 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3755 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003756
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003757 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3758 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3759 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3760 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3761 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003762
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003763 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003764 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3765 frontend www
3766 mode http
3767 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3768
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003769 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3770 backend www
3771 mode http
3772 option forwardfor header X-Client
3773
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003774 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3775 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003776
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003777
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003778option http-keep-alive
3779no option http-keep-alive
3780 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | yes | yes | yes
3783 Arguments : none
3784
3785 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3786 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3787 "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client- and
3788 server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3789 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3790 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3791 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3792 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3793 situations where this option may be useful :
3794
3795 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3796 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3797
3798 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3799 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3800
3801 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3802 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3803 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3804 request.
3805
3806 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3807 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003808 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3809 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3810 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003811
3812 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3813 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3814
3815 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3816 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3817 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3818 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3819 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3820 not set.
3821
3822 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3823 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3824 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3825 have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
3826
3827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3829
3830 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003831 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3832 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003833
3834
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003835option http-no-delay
3836no option http-no-delay
3837 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840 Arguments : none
3841
3842 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3843 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3844 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3845 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3846 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3847 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3848 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3849 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3850 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3851 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3852 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3853 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3854 affected.
3855
3856 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3857 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3858 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3859 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3860 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3861 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3862 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3863 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3864 latency environments.
3865
3866
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003867option http-pretend-keepalive
3868no option http-pretend-keepalive
3869 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 yes | yes | yes | yes
3872 Arguments : none
3873
3874 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3875 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3876 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3877 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3878 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3879 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3880 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3881 consider the response complete.
3882
3883 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3884 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3885 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3886 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3887 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3888 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3889
3890 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3891 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3892 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3893 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3894 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3895 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3896 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3897
3898 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3899 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003900 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003901 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3902 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003903
3904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3906
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003907 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3908 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003909
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003910
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003911option http-server-close
3912no option http-server-close
3913 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | yes | yes | yes
3916 Arguments : none
3917
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003918 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3919 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3920 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3921 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3922 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3923 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3924 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3925 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3926 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3927 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3928 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3929 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003930
3931 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3932 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3933 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3934 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003935 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3936 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003937
3938 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3939 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003940 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3941 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3942 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003943
3944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3946
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003947 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003948 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3949 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003950
3951
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003952option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003953no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003954 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3956 yes | yes | yes | no
3957 Arguments : none
3958
3959 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3960 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3961 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3962 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3963 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3964 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3965 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3966
3967 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3968 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3969 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3970 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3971 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3972 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3973 request along its whole life.
3974
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003975 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3976 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3977 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3978 front of an existing proxy.
3979
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003980 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3981
3982 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3983 http-server-close".
3984
3985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003986option httpchk
3987option httpchk <uri>
3988option httpchk <method> <uri>
3989option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3990 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | no | yes | yes
3993 Arguments :
3994 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3995 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3996 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3997 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3998 ones.
3999
4000 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4001 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4002 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4003
4004 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4005 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4006 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4007 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4008 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4009
4010 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4011 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4012 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4013 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4014 the lack of any response.
4015
4016 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4017
4018 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4019 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4020 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4021
4022 Examples :
4023 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4024 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4025 backend https_relay
4026 mode tcp
4027 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4028 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4029
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004030 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4031 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4032 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004033
4034
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004035option httpclose
4036no option httpclose
4037 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | yes | yes | yes
4040 Arguments : none
4041
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004042 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4043 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4044 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4045 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4046 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4047 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4048 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004049
4050 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004051 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004052 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4053 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4054 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4055 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4056 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004057
4058 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4059 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
4060 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004061 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
4062 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004063
4064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4066
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004067 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4068 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004069
4070
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004071option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004072 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4074 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004075 Arguments :
4076 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4077 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4078 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4079 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4080 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004081
4082 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4083 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4084 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4085 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4086 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4087 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4088 ports.
4089
4090 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4091
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004092 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4093 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4094 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4095 by default.
4096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004097 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004098
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004099
4100option http_proxy
4101no option http_proxy
4102 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4104 yes | yes | yes | yes
4105 Arguments : none
4106
4107 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4108 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4109 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4110 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4111 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4112
4113 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4114 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4115 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4116 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004117 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004118 be analyzed.
4119
4120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4122
4123 Example :
4124 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4125 backend direct_forward
4126 option httpclose
4127 option http_proxy
4128
4129 See also : "option httpclose"
4130
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004131
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004132option independent-streams
4133no option independent-streams
4134 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 yes | yes | yes | yes
4137 Arguments : none
4138
4139 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4140 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4141 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4142 receive data or not.
4143
4144 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4145 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4146 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4147 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4148 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4149 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4150 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4151 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4152 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4153 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4154 socket buffers.
4155
4156 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4157 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4158 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4159 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4160 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4161
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004162 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4163 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4164 deprecated.
4165
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004166 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004167
4168
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004169option ldap-check
4170 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4172 yes | no | yes | yes
4173 Arguments : none
4174
4175 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4176 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4177 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4178 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4179
4180 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4181 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4182
4183 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4184 configure it.
4185
4186 Example :
4187 option ldap-check
4188
4189 See also : "option httpchk"
4190
4191
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004192option log-health-checks
4193no option log-health-checks
4194 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | no | yes | yes
4197 Arguments : none
4198
4199 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4200 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4201 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4202 of additional information is limited.
4203
4204 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4205 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4206
4207 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4208
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004209
4210option log-separate-errors
4211no option log-separate-errors
4212 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4214 yes | yes | yes | no
4215 Arguments : none
4216
4217 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4218 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4219 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4220 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4221 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4222 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4223 provides very important information.
4224
4225 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4226 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4227 error logs.
4228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004229 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004230 logging.
4231
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004232
4233option logasap
4234no option logasap
4235 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4237 yes | yes | yes | no
4238 Arguments : none
4239
4240 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4241 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4242 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4243 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4244 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4245 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4246 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004247 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004248 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4249 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4250
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004251 Examples :
4252 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4253 mode http
4254 option httplog
4255 option logasap
4256 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4257
4258 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4259 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4260 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4261 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004263 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004264 logging.
4265
4266
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004267option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4268 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004271 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004272 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4273 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004274
4275 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4276 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4277 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4278 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4279 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4280 in the MySQL table, like this :
4281
4282 USE mysql;
4283 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4284 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4285
4286 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4287 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4288 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4289 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4290 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4291 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4292 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4293 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4294 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4295
4296 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4297 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004298
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004299 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004300
4301 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4302 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4303 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4304 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4305 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4306 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4307
4308 See also: "option httpchk"
4309
4310
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004311option nolinger
4312no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004313 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4315 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004316 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004317
4318 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4319 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4320 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4321 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4322 connections.
4323
4324 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4325 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4326 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4327 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4328 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4329 this too.
4330
4331 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4332 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4333 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4334
4335 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4336 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4337 for servers.
4338
4339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4341
4342
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004343option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4344 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4346 yes | yes | yes | yes
4347 Arguments :
4348 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4349 matching <network>
4350 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4351 header name.
4352
4353 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4354 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4355 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4356 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4357 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4358 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4359 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4360 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4361 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4362 possible that the client has already brought one.
4363
4364 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4365 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4366 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4367 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4368 header and requires different one.
4369
4370 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4371 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4372 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4373 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4374 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4375 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4376 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4377
4378 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4379 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4380 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4381 both are defined.
4382
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004383 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4384 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4385 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4386 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4387 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004388
4389 Examples :
4390 # Original Destination address
4391 frontend www
4392 mode http
4393 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4394
4395 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4396 backend www
4397 mode http
4398 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4399
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004400 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4401 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004402
4403
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004404option persist
4405no option persist
4406 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4407 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004409 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004410
4411 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4412 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4413 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4414 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4415 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4416 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4417 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4418 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4419 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4420 redirected to another valid server.
4421
4422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4424
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004425 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004426
4427
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004428option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4429 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 yes | no | yes | yes
4432 Arguments :
4433 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4434 PostgreSQL server.
4435
4436 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4437 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4438 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4439 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4440
4441 See also: "option httpchk"
4442
4443
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004444option prefer-last-server
4445no option prefer-last-server
4446 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 yes | no | yes | yes
4449 Arguments : none
4450
4451 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4452 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4453 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4454 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4455 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4456 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4457 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4458 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4459 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004460 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4461 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4462 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4463 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4464 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4465 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4466 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004467
4468 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4469 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4470
4471 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4472
4473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004474option redispatch
4475no option redispatch
4476 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004479 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004480
4481 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4482 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4483 be able to access the service anymore.
4484
4485 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4486 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4487
4488 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4489 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4490 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004492 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4493 "redisp" keywords.
4494
4495 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4496 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4497
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004498 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004499
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004500
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004501option redis-check
4502 Use redis health checks for server testing
4503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4504 yes | no | yes | yes
4505 Arguments : none
4506
4507 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4508 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4509 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4510 find the "+PONG" response message.
4511
4512 Example :
4513 option redis-check
4514
4515 See also : "option httpchk"
4516
4517
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004518option smtpchk
4519option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4520 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004523 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004524 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4525 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4526 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4527
4528 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4529 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4530 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4531
4532 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4533 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4534 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4535 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4536 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4537 dead server.
4538
4539 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4540 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4541 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4542 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4543
4544 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4545 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4546 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4547 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4548 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4549
4550 Example :
4551 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4552
4553 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004556option socket-stats
4557no option socket-stats
4558
4559 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4561 yes | yes | yes | no
4562
4563 Arguments : none
4564
4565
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004566option splice-auto
4567no option splice-auto
4568 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | yes | yes | yes
4571 Arguments : none
4572
4573 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4574 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4575 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4576 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004577 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004578 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4579 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4580 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4581 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4582
4583 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4584 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4585 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4586 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4587 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4588 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4589 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4590 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4591 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4592 keyword.
4593
4594 Example :
4595 option splice-auto
4596
4597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4599
4600 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4601 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4602
4603
4604option splice-request
4605no option splice-request
4606 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments : none
4610
4611 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004612 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004613 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4614 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4615 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4616 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4617
4618 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4619
4620 Example :
4621 option splice-request
4622
4623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4625
4626 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4627 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4628
4629
4630option splice-response
4631no option splice-response
4632 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 yes | yes | yes | yes
4635 Arguments : none
4636
4637 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004638 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004639 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4640 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4641 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4642 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4643
4644 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4645
4646 Example :
4647 option splice-response
4648
4649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4651
4652 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4653 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4654
4655
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004656option srvtcpka
4657no option srvtcpka
4658 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4660 yes | no | yes | yes
4661 Arguments : none
4662
4663 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4664 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4665 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4666 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4667
4668 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4669 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4670 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4671 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4672
4673 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4674 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4675 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4676 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4677 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4678
4679 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4680
4681 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4682 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4683 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4684
4685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4687
4688 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4689
4690
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004691option ssl-hello-chk
4692 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | no | yes | yes
4695 Arguments : none
4696
4697 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4698 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4699 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4700 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4701 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4702 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4703 hello message.
4704
4705 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4706 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4707 messages, which is appreciable.
4708
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004709 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4710 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4711 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004712
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004713 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4714
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004715
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004716option tcp-check
4717 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4718 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4719 yes | no | yes | yes
4720
4721 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4722 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4723
4724 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4725 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4726 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4727
4728 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4729 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4730 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4731 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4732 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4733 only.
4734
4735 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4736 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4737 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4738 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4739 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4740
4741 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4742 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4743 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4744 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4745 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4746 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4747 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4748 the respective protocols.
4749 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4750 analysed.
4751
4752 Examples :
4753 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4754 option tcp-check
4755 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4756
4757 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4758 option tcp-check
4759 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4760
4761 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4762 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4763 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4764 option tcp-check
4765 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4766 tcp-check expect +PONG
4767 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4768 tcp-check expect string role:master
4769 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4770 tcp-check expect string +OK
4771
4772 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4773 (send many headers before analyzing)
4774 option tcp-check
4775 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4776 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4777 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4778 tcp-check send \r\n
4779 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4780
4781
4782 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4783
4784
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004785option tcp-smart-accept
4786no option tcp-smart-accept
4787 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 yes | yes | yes | no
4790 Arguments : none
4791
4792 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4793 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4794 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4795 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4796 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4797 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4798
4799 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4800 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4801 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4802 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4803
4804 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4805 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4806 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4807 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4808
4809 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4810 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4811 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4812
4813 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4814 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4815 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4816
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004817 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4818
4819
4820option tcp-smart-connect
4821no option tcp-smart-connect
4822 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | no | yes | yes
4825 Arguments : none
4826
4827 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4828 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4829 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4830 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4831 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4832
4833 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4834 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4835 complex.
4836
4837 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4838 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4839 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4840
4841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4843
4844 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4845
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004847option tcpka
4848 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | yes | yes | yes
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4854 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4855 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4856 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4857
4858 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4859 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4860 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4861 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4862
4863 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4864 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4865 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4866 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4867 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4868
4869 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4870
4871 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4872 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4873 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4874 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4875 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4876 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4877 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4878 backends.
4879
4880 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4881
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004882
4883option tcplog
4884 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | yes
4887 Arguments : none
4888
4889 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4890 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4891 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4892 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4893 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4894 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4895 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4896 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4897
4898 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004900 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004901
4902
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004903option transparent
4904no option transparent
4905 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004907 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004908 Arguments : none
4909
4910 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4911 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4912 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4913 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4914 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4915 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4916 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4917 appropriate server.
4918
4919 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4920 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4921
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004922 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004923 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004924
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004925
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004926persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004927persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004928 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 yes | no | yes | yes
4931 Arguments :
4932 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004933 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4934 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004935
4936 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4937 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4938 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4939 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4940 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4941 forwarded to this server.
4942
4943 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4944 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4945 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004946 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004947 a single "listen" section.
4948
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004949 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4950 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4951 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4952
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004953 Example :
4954 listen tse-farm
4955 bind :3389
4956 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4957 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4958 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4959 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4960 persist rdp-cookie
4961 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004962 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004963 balance rdp-cookie
4964 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4965 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4966
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004967 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4968 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004969
4970
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004971rate-limit sessions <rate>
4972 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | yes | yes | no
4975 Arguments :
4976 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4977 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4978
4979 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4980 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4981 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4982 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4983 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4984 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4985
4986 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4987 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4988 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4989 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4990
4991 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4992 listen smtp
4993 mode tcp
4994 bind :25
4995 rate-limit sessions 10
4996 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4997
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004998 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4999 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5000 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005001
5002 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5003
5004
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005005redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5006redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5007redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005008 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 no | yes | yes | yes
5011
5012 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005013 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005014
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005015 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005016 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005017 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5018 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5019 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005020
5021 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5022 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5023 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5024 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5025 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005026 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5027 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5028 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5029 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005030
5031 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5032 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5033 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5034 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5035 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5036 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5037 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5038 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005039 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5040 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5041 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005042
5043 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005044 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5045 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5046 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5047 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5048 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5049 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5050 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5051 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005052
5053 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5054 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5055
5056 - "drop-query"
5057 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5058 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5059 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5060 with a location-type redirect.
5061
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005062 - "append-slash"
5063 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5064 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5065 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5066 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5067
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005068 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5069 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5070 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5071 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5072 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5073 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5074 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5075
5076 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5077 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5078 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5079 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5080 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5081 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5082 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005083
5084 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5085 acl clear dst_port 80
5086 acl secure dst_port 8080
5087 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005088 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005089 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005090 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5091
5092 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005093 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5094 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5095 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005096 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005097
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005098 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5099 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5100 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5101
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005102 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005103 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005104
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005105 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5106 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5107 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005109 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005110
5111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005112redisp (deprecated)
5113redispatch (deprecated)
5114 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005117 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005118
5119 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5120 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5121 be able to access the service anymore.
5122
5123 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5124 redistribute them to a working server.
5125
5126 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5127 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5128 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005130 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5131 "option redispatch" instead.
5132
5133 See also : "option redispatch"
5134
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005135
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005136reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005137 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5139 no | yes | yes | yes
5140 Arguments :
5141 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5142 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005144
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005145 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5146 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5147
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005148 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5149 the last header of an HTTP request.
5150
5151 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5152 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5153 responses.
5154
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005155 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5156 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5157 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5158
5159 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5160 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005161
5162
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005163reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5164reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005165 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5167 no | yes | yes | yes
5168 Arguments :
5169 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5170 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5171 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5172 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5173 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5174 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5175 ignores case.
5176
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005177 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5178 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5179
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005180 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5181 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5182 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5183 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005184 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005185
5186 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5187 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5188
5189 Example :
5190 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5191 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5192 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5193
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005194 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5195 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005196
5197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005198reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5199reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005200 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5202 no | yes | yes | yes
5203 Arguments :
5204 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5205 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5206 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5207 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5208 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5209 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5210
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005211 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5212 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5213
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005214 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5215 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5216 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5217 next servers.
5218
5219 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5220 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5221 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5222
5223 Example :
5224 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5225 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5226 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5227
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005228 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5229 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005230
5231
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005232reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5233reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005234 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 no | yes | yes | yes
5237 Arguments :
5238 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5239 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5240 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5241 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5242 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5243 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5244 case.
5245
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005246 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5247 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5248
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005249 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5250 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5251 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5252 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005253 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005254
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005255 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005256 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005257 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005258
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005259 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5260 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5261
5262 Example :
5263 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5264 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5265 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5266
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005267 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5268 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005269
5270
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005271reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5272reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005273 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 no | yes | yes | yes
5276 Arguments :
5277 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5278 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5279 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5280 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5281 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5282 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5283 case.
5284
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005285 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5286 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5287
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005288 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5289 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5290 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5291 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5292
5293 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5294 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5295
5296 Example :
5297 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5298 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5299 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5300 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5301
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005302 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5303 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005304
5305
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005306reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5307reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005308 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 no | yes | yes | yes
5311 Arguments :
5312 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5313 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5314 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5315 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5316 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5317 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5318
5319 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5320 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5321 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5322 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005323 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005324
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005325 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5326 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5327
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005328 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5329 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5330 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5331
5332 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5333 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5334 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5335 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5336 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5337
5338 Example :
5339 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005340 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005341 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5342 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5343
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005344 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5345 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005346
5347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005348reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5349reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005350 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5352 no | yes | yes | yes
5353 Arguments :
5354 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5355 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5356 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5357 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5358 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5359 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5360 ignores case.
5361
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005362 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5363 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5364
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005365 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5366 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005367 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5368 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5369 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005370 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5371 not set.
5372
5373 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5374 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5375 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5376 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5377 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005379 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005380 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5381 # block all others.
5382 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5383 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5384
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005385 # block bad guys
5386 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5387 reqitarpit . if badguys
5388
5389 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5390 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005391
5392
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005393retries <value>
5394 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | no | yes | yes
5397 Arguments :
5398 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5399 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5400 default value is 3.
5401
5402 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5403 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5404 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5405
5406 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5407 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5408
5409 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5410 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5411
5412 See also : "option redispatch"
5413
5414
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005415rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005416 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 no | yes | yes | yes
5419 Arguments :
5420 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5421 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005422 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005423
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005424 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5425 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5426
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005427 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5428 the last header of an HTTP response.
5429
5430 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5431 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5432 responses.
5433
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005434 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5435 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005436
5437
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005438rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5439rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005440 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 no | yes | yes | yes
5443 Arguments :
5444 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5445 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5446 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5447 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5448 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5449 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5450 ignores case.
5451
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005452 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5453 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5454
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005455 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5456 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005457 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005458 client.
5459
5460 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5461 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5462 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5463
5464 Example :
5465 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005466 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005467
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005468 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5469 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005470
5471
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005472rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5473rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005474 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 no | yes | yes | yes
5477 Arguments :
5478 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5479 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5480 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5481 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5482 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5483 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5484 ignores case.
5485
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005486 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5487 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5488
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005489 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5490 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5491 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5492 case-sensitive.
5493
5494 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005495 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5496 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5497 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005498
5499 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5500 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5501
5502 Example :
5503 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5504 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5505
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005506 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5507 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005508
5509
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005510rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5511rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005512 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5514 no | yes | yes | yes
5515 Arguments :
5516 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5517 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5518 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5519 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5520 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5521 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5522 ignores case.
5523
5524 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5525 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5526 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5527 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005528 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005529
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005530 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5531 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5532
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005533 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5534 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5535 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5536
5537 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5538 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5539 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5540 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5541 are not case-sensitive.
5542
5543 Example :
5544 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5545 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5546
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005547 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5548 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005549
5550
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005551server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005552 Declare a server in a backend
5553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5554 no | no | yes | yes
5555 Arguments :
5556 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005557 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005558 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005559
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005560 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5561 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5562 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5563 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005564 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5565 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5566 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5567 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5568 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005569 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5570 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5571 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5572 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5573 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5574 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5575 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005576 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5577 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5578 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5579 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005581 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005582 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5583 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5584 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5585 adding this value to the client's port.
5586
5587 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5588 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005589 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005590
5591 Examples :
5592 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5593 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005594 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005595 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5596 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5597 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005598
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005599 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5600 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005601
5602
5603source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005604source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005605source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005606 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5608 yes | no | yes | yes
5609 Arguments :
5610 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5611 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005612
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005613 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005614 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5615 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5616 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5617 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5618 supported prefixes are :
5619 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5620 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5621 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005622 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5623 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5624 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5625 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005626
5627 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5628 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005629 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5630 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5631 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005632
5633 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5634 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5635 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5636 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5637 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5638 <addr>.
5639
5640 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5641 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5642 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5643 port.
5644
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005645 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5646 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5647 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5648 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005649 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005650 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5651 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5652 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5653 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5654 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5655 HTTP header.
5656
5657 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5658 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005659 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005660 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5661 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5662 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5663 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5664 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5665 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5666 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5667
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005668 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5669 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5670 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5671 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5672 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5673 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5674
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005675 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5676 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5677 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5678 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5679
5680 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5681 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5682 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5683 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5684 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5685 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5686
5687 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5688 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5689 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5690 there are two methods :
5691
5692 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5693 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5694 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5695 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5696 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5697 of the client ranges may be used.
5698
5699 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5700 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5701 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5702 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5703 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5704 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5705 same session.
5706
5707 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5708 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5709 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5710 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5711 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5712 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5713
5714 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5715 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5716 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005717 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005718
5719 Examples :
5720 backend private
5721 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5722 source 192.168.1.200
5723
5724 backend transparent_ssl1
5725 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5726 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5727
5728 backend transparent_ssl2
5729 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5730 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5731 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5732
5733 backend transparent_ssl3
5734 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5735 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5736 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5737
5738 backend transparent_smtp
5739 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5740 # with Tproxy version 4.
5741 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5742
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005743 backend transparent_http
5744 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5745 # proxy.
5746 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005748 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005749 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005751
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005752srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5753 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5755 yes | no | yes | yes
5756 Arguments :
5757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5759 as explained at the top of this document.
5760
5761 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5762 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5763 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5764 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5765 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5766 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5767 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5768
5769 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5770 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5771 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5772 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5773 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005774 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005775 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005776 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005777
5778 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5779 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5780 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5781 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5782 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5783 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5784
5785 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5786 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5787
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005788 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5789 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005790
5791
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005792stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5793 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5795 no | no | yes | yes
5796
5797 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5798 matched.
5799
5800 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5801 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5802
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005803 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5804 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5805 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5806
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005807 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5808 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5809 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5810 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005811
5812 Example :
5813 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5814 backend stats_localhost
5815 stats enable
5816 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5817
5818 Example :
5819 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5820 backend stats_auth
5821 stats enable
5822 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5823 stats admin if TRUE
5824
5825 Example :
5826 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5827 userlist stats-auth
5828 group admin users admin
5829 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5830 group readonly users haproxy
5831 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5832
5833 backend stats_auth
5834 stats enable
5835 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5836 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5837 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5838 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5839
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005840 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5841 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5842 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005843
5844
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005845stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5846 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5848 yes | no | yes | yes
5849 Arguments :
5850 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5851
5852 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5853
5854 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5855 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5856 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5857 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5858 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5859 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5860
5861 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5862 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5863 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005864 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005865
5866 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5867 report using "stats scope".
5868
5869 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5870 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5871 unobvious parameters.
5872
5873 Example :
5874 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5875 backend public_www
5876 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5877 stats enable
5878 stats hide-version
5879 stats scope .
5880 stats uri /admin?stats
5881 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5882 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5883 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5884
5885 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5886 backend private_monitoring
5887 stats enable
5888 stats uri /admin?stats
5889 stats refresh 5s
5890
5891 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5892
5893
5894stats enable
5895 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5897 yes | no | yes | yes
5898 Arguments : none
5899
5900 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5901 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5902 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5903 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5904 - stats auth : no authentication
5905 - stats scope : no restriction
5906
5907 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5908 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5909 unobvious parameters.
5910
5911 Example :
5912 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5913 backend public_www
5914 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5915 stats enable
5916 stats hide-version
5917 stats scope .
5918 stats uri /admin?stats
5919 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5920 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5921 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5922
5923 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5924 backend private_monitoring
5925 stats enable
5926 stats uri /admin?stats
5927 stats refresh 5s
5928
5929 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5930
5931
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005932stats hide-version
5933 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005936 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005937
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005938 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5939 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5940 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5941 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5942 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5943 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005945 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5946 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5947 unobvious parameters.
5948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005949 Example :
5950 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5951 backend public_www
5952 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005953 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005954 stats hide-version
5955 stats scope .
5956 stats uri /admin?stats
5957 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5958 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5959 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005960
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005961 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5962 backend private_monitoring
5963 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005964 stats uri /admin?stats
5965 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005966
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005967 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005968
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005969
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005970stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5971 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5972 Access control for statistics
5973
5974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5975 no | no | yes | yes
5976
5977 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5978 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5979 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5980 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5981 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5982 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5983
5984 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5985 instance.
5986
5987 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5988 about ACL usage.
5989
5990
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005991stats realm <realm>
5992 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | no | yes | yes
5995 Arguments :
5996 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5997 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5998 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5999
6000 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6001 using a backslash ('\').
6002
6003 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6004 only related to authentication.
6005
6006 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6007 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6008 unobvious parameters.
6009
6010 Example :
6011 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6012 backend public_www
6013 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6014 stats enable
6015 stats hide-version
6016 stats scope .
6017 stats uri /admin?stats
6018 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6019 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6020 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6021
6022 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6023 backend private_monitoring
6024 stats enable
6025 stats uri /admin?stats
6026 stats refresh 5s
6027
6028 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6029
6030
6031stats refresh <delay>
6032 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6034 yes | no | yes | yes
6035 Arguments :
6036 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6037 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6038 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6039 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6040 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6041 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6042
6043 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6044 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6045 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6046 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6047
6048 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6049 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6050 unobvious parameters.
6051
6052 Example :
6053 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6054 backend public_www
6055 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6056 stats enable
6057 stats hide-version
6058 stats scope .
6059 stats uri /admin?stats
6060 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6061 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6062 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6063
6064 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6065 backend private_monitoring
6066 stats enable
6067 stats uri /admin?stats
6068 stats refresh 5s
6069
6070 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6071
6072
6073stats scope { <name> | "." }
6074 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6076 yes | no | yes | yes
6077 Arguments :
6078 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6079 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6080 section in which the statement appears.
6081
6082 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6083 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6084 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6085 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6086 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6087 exists.
6088
6089 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6090 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6091 unobvious parameters.
6092
6093 Example :
6094 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6095 backend public_www
6096 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6097 stats enable
6098 stats hide-version
6099 stats scope .
6100 stats uri /admin?stats
6101 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6102 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6103 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6104
6105 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6106 backend private_monitoring
6107 stats enable
6108 stats uri /admin?stats
6109 stats refresh 5s
6110
6111 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6112
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006113
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006114stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006115 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | no | yes | yes
6118
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006119 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006120 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6121
6122 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6123 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6124
6125 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6126 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006127 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006128
6129 Example :
6130 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6131 backend private_monitoring
6132 stats enable
6133 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6134 stats uri /admin?stats
6135 stats refresh 5s
6136
6137 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6138 global section.
6139
6140
6141stats show-legends
6142 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6143 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6144 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6145 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6146 - IP (socket, server)
6147 - cookie (backend, server)
6148
6149 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6150 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006151 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006152
6153 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6154
6155
6156stats show-node [ <name> ]
6157 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6159 yes | no | yes | yes
6160 Arguments:
6161 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6162 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6163
6164 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6165 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006166 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006167
6168 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6169 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6170 unobvious parameters.
6171
6172 Example:
6173 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6174 backend private_monitoring
6175 stats enable
6176 stats show-node Europe-1
6177 stats uri /admin?stats
6178 stats refresh 5s
6179
6180 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6181 section.
6182
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006183
6184stats uri <prefix>
6185 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6187 yes | no | yes | yes
6188 Arguments :
6189 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6190 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6191 query string.
6192
6193 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6194 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6195 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6196 possible to reach it in the application.
6197
6198 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006199 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006200 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6201 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6202 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6203 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6204
6205 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6206 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6207 an address or a port to statistics only.
6208
6209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6211 unobvious parameters.
6212
6213 Example :
6214 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6215 backend public_www
6216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6217 stats enable
6218 stats hide-version
6219 stats scope .
6220 stats uri /admin?stats
6221 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6222 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6223 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6224
6225 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6226 backend private_monitoring
6227 stats enable
6228 stats uri /admin?stats
6229 stats refresh 5s
6230
6231 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6232
6233
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006234stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6235 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006237 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006238
6239 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006240 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006241 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6242 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6243 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6244
6245 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6246 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6247 the "stick-table" statement.
6248
6249 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6250 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6251 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6252 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6253 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6254
6255 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6256 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6257 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6258 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6259 transformation rules.
6260
6261 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6262 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6263 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6264 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6265 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6266 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6267 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6268
6269 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6270 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6271 ACL based conditions.
6272
6273 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6274 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6275 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6276 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6277
6278 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6279 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6280 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6281 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6282
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006283 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6284 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6285 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6286
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006287 Example :
6288 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6289 # last 30 minutes
6290 backend pop
6291 mode tcp
6292 balance roundrobin
6293 stick store-request src
6294 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6295 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6296 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6297
6298 backend smtp
6299 mode tcp
6300 balance roundrobin
6301 stick match src table pop
6302 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6303 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6304
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006305 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6306 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006307
6308
6309stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6310 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6312 no | no | yes | yes
6313
6314 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6315 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6316 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6317 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6318
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006319 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6320 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6321 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6322
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006323 Examples :
6324 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006325 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006326
6327 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6328 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6329 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6330
6331
6332 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6333 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6334 backend http
6335 mode http
6336 balance roundrobin
6337 stick on src table https
6338 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6339 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6340 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6341
6342 backend https
6343 mode tcp
6344 balance roundrobin
6345 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6346 stick on src
6347 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6348 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6349
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006350 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006351
6352
6353stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6354 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 no | no | yes | yes
6357
6358 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006359 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006360 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6361 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6362 server is selected.
6363
6364 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6365 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6366 the "stick-table" statement.
6367
6368 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6369 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6370 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6371 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6372 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6373 address.
6374
6375 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6376 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6377 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6378 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6379 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6380 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6381 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6382 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6383 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6384 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6385
6386 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6387 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6388 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6389 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6390 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6391 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6392 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6393
6394 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6395 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6396 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6397 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6398
6399 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6400 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6401 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6402 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6403 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6404 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006405 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6406 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6407 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6408 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6409 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6410 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006411
6412 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6413 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6414 the request.
6415
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006416 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6417 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6418 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6419
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006420 Example :
6421 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6422 # last 30 minutes
6423 backend pop
6424 mode tcp
6425 balance roundrobin
6426 stick store-request src
6427 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6428 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6429 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6430
6431 backend smtp
6432 mode tcp
6433 balance roundrobin
6434 stick match src table pop
6435 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6436 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6437
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006438 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6439 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006440
6441
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006442stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006443 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6444 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006445 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006447 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006448
6449 Arguments :
6450 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6451 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6452 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6453 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6454
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006455 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6456 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6457 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6458 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6459
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006460 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6461 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6462 instance.
6463
6464 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6465 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6466 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6467 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6468 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6469 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006470 to 32 characters.
6471
6472 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6473 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6474 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6475 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6476 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6477 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006478
6479 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006480 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6481 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006482 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6483 increase.
6484
6485 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006486 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6487 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6488 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006489
6490 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6491 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6492 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6493 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6494 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6495 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6496 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6497 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6498 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6499 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6500 parameter (see below).
6501
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006502 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6503 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6504 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6505 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6506 soft restart.
6507
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006508 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6509
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006510 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6511 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6512 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6513 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6514 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006515 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006516 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6517 if not expiration delay is specified.
6518
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006519 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6520 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6521 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6522 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006523 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6524 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6525 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6526 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6527 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6528 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6529 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6530 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6531 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6532 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6533 types and their arguments.
6534
6535 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6536 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6537 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6538 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6539
6540 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6541 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6542 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6543 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6544
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006545 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6546 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6547 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6548 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6549 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6550 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6551
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006552 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6553 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6554 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6555 they were received.
6556
6557 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6558 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6559 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6560 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6561 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6562
6563 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6564 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6565 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6566 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6567 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6568
6569 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6570 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6571 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6572
6573 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6574 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6575 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6576 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6577 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6578
6579 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6580 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6581 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6582 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6583 the client side.
6584
6585 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6586 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6587 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6588 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6589 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6590 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6591 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6592
6593 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6594 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6595 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6596 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6597 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6598 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6599 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6600
6601 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6602 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6603 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6604 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6605 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6606 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6607
6608 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6609 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6610 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6611 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6612
6613 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6614 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6615 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6616 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6617 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6618 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6619 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6620 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6621 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6622 recommended for better fairness.
6623
6624 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6625 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6626 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6627 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6628
6629 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6630 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6631 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6632 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6633 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6634 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6635 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6636 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6637 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6638 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006639
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006640 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6641 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006642 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6643 reference it.
6644
6645 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6646 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6647 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6648 as an exclusive stickiness.
6649
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006650 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6651 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6652 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6653 something that can be ignored.
6654
6655 Example:
6656 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6657 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6658 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6659 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6660
6661 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006662 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006663
6664
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006665stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6666 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 no | no | yes | yes
6669
6670 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006671 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006672 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6673 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6674 server is selected.
6675
6676 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6677 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6678 the "stick-table" statement.
6679
6680 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6681 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6682 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6683 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6684
6685 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6686 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6687 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6688 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6689 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6690 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006691 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006692 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6693 rules.
6694
6695 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6696 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6697 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6698 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6699 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6700 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6701 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6702
6703 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6704 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6705 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6706 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6707
6708 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6709 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6710 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6711 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6712 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6713 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006714 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6715 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6716 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6717 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6718 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6719 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6720 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6721 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6722 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006723
6724 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6725
6726 Example :
6727 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6728 backend https
6729 mode tcp
6730 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006731 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006732 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006733
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006734 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6735 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6736
6737 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6738 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6739 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6740
6741 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6742 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006743
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006744 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6745 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6746 # at offset 44.
6747
6748 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6749 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6750
6751 # Learn on response if server hello.
6752 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006753
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006754 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6755 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6756
6757 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6758 extraction.
6759
6760
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006761tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6762 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006765 Arguments :
6766 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006767 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6768 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006769
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006770 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006771
6772 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6773 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006774 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6775 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6776 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6777 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6778 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6779 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006780
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006781 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6782 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6783 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6784 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006785
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006786 Three types of actions are supported :
6787 - accept :
6788 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6789 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6790 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006791
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006792 - reject :
6793 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6794 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6795 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6796 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6797 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6798 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6799 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6800 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6801 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6802 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6803 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6804 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006805
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006806 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6807 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6808 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6809 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6810 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6811 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6812 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6813 hosts.
6814
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006815 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006816 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6817 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6818 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006819 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6820 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006821 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006822 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6823 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6824 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6825 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6826 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006828 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006829 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006830 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006831 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6832 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6833 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6834 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006835
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006836 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6837 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6838 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6839 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006841 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6842 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6843 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6844 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6845 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006846 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6847 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6848 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6849 layer7 information is extracted.
6850
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006851 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6852 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6853 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6854 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6855 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006857 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6858 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6859 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006861 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6862 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6863 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006865 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006866 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006867 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006868
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006869 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6870 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6871 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006873 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006874 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6875 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006876
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006877 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6878
6879 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6880
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006881 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006883 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006884
6885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006886tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6887 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006889 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006890 Arguments :
6891 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006892 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6893 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006894 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006896 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006897
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006898 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6899 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6900 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6901 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6902 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006903
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006904 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6905 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6906 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6907 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6908 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6909 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6910 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6911 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6912 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006913
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006914 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6915 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6916 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6917 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006918
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006919 Three types of actions are supported :
6920 - accept :
6921 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006922 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006924 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6925 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006927 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6928 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6929 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006930 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6931 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6932 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6933 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006934 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6935 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006936 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006938 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006939 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6940 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006942 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006943 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6944 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6945 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6946 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6947 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006948
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006949 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6950 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6951 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6952 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6953
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006954 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006955 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6956 # and reject everything else.
6957 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6958 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006959 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006960 tcp-request content reject
6961
6962 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006963 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6964 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6965 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006966 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006967
6968 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6969 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6970 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006971 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006972 tcp-request content reject
6973
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006974 Example:
6975 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6976 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006977 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006978
6979 Example:
6980 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6981 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006982 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006984 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6985 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6986
6987 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006988 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006989 # protecting all our sites
6990 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006991 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6992 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006993 ...
6994 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6995
6996 backend http_dynamic
6997 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006998 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006999 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007000 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7001 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7002 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007003 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007005 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007007 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007008
7009
7010tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7011 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007013 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007014 Arguments :
7015 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7016 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7017 as explained at the top of this document.
7018
7019 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7020 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7021 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7022 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7023 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7024
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007025 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7026 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7027 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7028 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7029
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007030 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7031 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007032 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007033 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007034 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7035 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7036 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7037 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007038
7039 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7040 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7041 it pass through unaffected.
7042
7043 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7044 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7045 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007046 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007047 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7048 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007049 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7050 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7051 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007052
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007053 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007054 "timeout client".
7055
7056
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007057tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7058 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 no | no | yes | yes
7061 Arguments :
7062 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007063 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007064
7065 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7066
7067 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7068 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7069 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007070 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7071 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007072
7073 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7074
7075 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7076 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7077 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7078 inserted.
7079
7080 Two types of actions are supported :
7081 - accept :
7082 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7083 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7084 the rules evaluation.
7085
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007086 - close :
7087 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7088 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7089 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7090 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7091 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7092 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7093 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7094 protocols.
7095
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007096 - reject :
7097 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7098 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007099 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007100
7101 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7102 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7103 for changing the default action to a reject.
7104
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007105 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7106 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7107 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7108 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007109 period.
7110
7111 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7112
7113 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7114
7115
7116tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7117 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7119 no | no | yes | yes
7120 Arguments :
7121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7123 as explained at the top of this document.
7124
7125 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7126
7127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007128timeout check <timeout>
7129 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7130 established.
7131
7132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7133 yes | no | yes | yes
7134 Arguments:
7135 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7136 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7137 as explained at the top of this document.
7138
7139 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7140 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7141 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7142 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007143 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7144 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7145 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007146
7147 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7148 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7149
7150 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7151 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007152 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007153
7154 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7155 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7156 forget about it.
7157
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007158 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7159 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007160
7161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007162timeout client <timeout>
7163timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7164 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 yes | yes | yes | no
7167 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007168 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007169 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7170 as explained at the top of this document.
7171
7172 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7173 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7174 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7175 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7176 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7177 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7178 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7179 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007180 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007181 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007182 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7183 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7184 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007185
7186 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7187 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7188 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7189 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7190 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7191 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7192
7193 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7194 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7195 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7196
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007197 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007198
7199
7200timeout connect <timeout>
7201timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7202 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7204 yes | no | yes | yes
7205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7208 as explained at the top of this document.
7209
7210 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007211 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007212 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007213 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007214 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7215 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007216
7217 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7218 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7219 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7220 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7221 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7222 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7223
7224 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7225 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7226 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7227
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007228 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7229 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007230
7231
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007232timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7233 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7235 yes | yes | yes | yes
7236 Arguments :
7237 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7238 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7239 as explained at the top of this document.
7240
7241 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7242 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7243 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7244 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7245 once the request has started to present itself.
7246
7247 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7248 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7249 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7250 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7251 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7252
7253 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7254 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7255 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7256 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7257
7258 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7259 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7260 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7261 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7262 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007263 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007264
7265 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7266 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7267 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7268 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7269
7270 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7271
7272
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007273timeout http-request <timeout>
7274 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007276 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007277 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7280 as explained at the top of this document.
7281
7282 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7283 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7284 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7285 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7286 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7287 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7288 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7289 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7290
7291 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7292 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007293 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7294 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007295
7296 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7297 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7298 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7299 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7300 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7301
7302 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007303 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7304 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7305 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007306
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007307 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007308
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007309
7310timeout queue <timeout>
7311 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 yes | no | yes | yes
7314 Arguments :
7315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7317 as explained at the top of this document.
7318
7319 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7320 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7321 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7322 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7323 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7324
7325 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7326 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7327 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7328 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7329
7330 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7331
7332
7333timeout server <timeout>
7334timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7335 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | no | yes | yes
7338 Arguments :
7339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7341 as explained at the top of this document.
7342
7343 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7344 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7345 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7346 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7347 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7348 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7349 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7350
7351 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7352 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7353 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7354 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7355 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007356 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007357 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007358 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7359 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7360 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7361 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007362
7363 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7364 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7365 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7366 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7367 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7368 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7369
7370 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7371 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7372 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7373
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007374 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007375
7376
7377timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007378 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7380 yes | yes | yes | yes
7381 Arguments :
7382 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7384 as explained at the top of this document.
7385
7386 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7387 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7388 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7389
7390 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7391 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7392 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7393 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007394 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007395
7396 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7397
7398
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007399timeout tunnel <timeout>
7400 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 yes | no | yes | yes
7403 Arguments :
7404 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7405 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7406 as explained at the top of this document.
7407
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007408 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007409 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7410 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7411 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7412 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7413 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7414 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7415 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7416 specified.
7417
7418 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7419 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7420 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7421 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7422 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7423
7424 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7425 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7426 forget about it.
7427
7428 Example :
7429 defaults http
7430 option http-server-close
7431 timeout connect 5s
7432 timeout client 30s
7433 timeout client 30s
7434 timeout server 30s
7435 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7436
7437 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7438
7439
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007440transparent (deprecated)
7441 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007443 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007444 Arguments : none
7445
7446 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7447 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7448 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7449 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7450 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7451 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7452 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7453 appropriate server.
7454
7455 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7456
7457 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7458 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7459
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007460 See also: "option transparent"
7461
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007462unique-id-format <string>
7463 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7465 yes | yes | yes | no
7466 Arguments :
7467 <string> is a log-format string.
7468
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007469 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7470 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7471 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7472 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007473
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007474 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7475 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7476 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7477 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7478 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7479 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7480 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7481 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007482
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007483 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7484 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007485
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007486 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007487
7488 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7489
7490 will generate:
7491
7492 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7493
7494 See also: "unique-id-header"
7495
7496unique-id-header <name>
7497 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 yes | yes | yes | no
7500 Arguments :
7501 <name> is the name of the header.
7502
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007503 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7504 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007505
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007506 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007507
7508 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7509 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7510
7511 will generate:
7512
7513 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7514
7515 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007516
7517use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7518use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007519 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 no | yes | yes | no
7522 Arguments :
7523 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007525 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007526
7527 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7528 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7529 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007530 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7531 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7532 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7533 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007534
7535 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7536 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7537 assign the backend.
7538
7539 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7540 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7541 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7542 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7543 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7544 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7545
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007546 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007547 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007548 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7549 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7550 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7551
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007552 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007553
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007554
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007555use-server <server> if <condition>
7556use-server <server> unless <condition>
7557 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7559 no | no | yes | yes
7560 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007561 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007562
7563 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7564
7565 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7566 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7567 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7568
7569 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7570 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7571 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7572 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7573 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7574 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7575 matches will assign the server.
7576
7577 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7578 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7579 with the next rules until one matches.
7580
7581 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7582 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7583 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7584 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7585
7586 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7587 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7588 stripped.
7589
7590 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7591 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7592 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7593 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7594
7595 Example :
7596 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7597 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7598 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7599 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7600 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7601 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7602 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7603 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7604 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7605
7606 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7607
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007608
76095. Bind and Server options
7610--------------------------
7611
7612The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7613depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7614settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7615written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7616described in this section.
7617
7618
76195.1. Bind options
7620-----------------
7621
7622The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7623as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7624no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7625parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7626while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7627provided immediately after the setting name.
7628
7629The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7630
7631accept-proxy
7632 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7633 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7634 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7635 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7636 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7637 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7638 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7639 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7640 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007641 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7642 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007643
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007644alpn <protocols>
7645 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7646 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7647 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7648 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7649 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7650 initial NPN extension.
7651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007652backlog <backlog>
7653 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7654 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7655
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007656ecdhe <named curve>
7657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007658 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7659 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007660
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007661ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7663 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7664 client's certificate.
7665
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007666ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7668 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7669 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7670 error is ignored.
7671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007672ciphers <ciphers>
7673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7674 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7675 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7676 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7677 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7678
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007679crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7681 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7682 to verify client's certificate.
7683
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007684crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7686 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7687 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7688 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7689 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7690 file.
7691
7692 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7693 are loaded.
7694
7695 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7696 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7697 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7698 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7699 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7700 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7701 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7702 www.sub.example.org).
7703
7704 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7705 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7706 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7707 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7708 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7709
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007710 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007711
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007712 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7713 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7714 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7715 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7716 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7717 clients).
7718
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007719crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7721 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7722 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7723 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007724
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007725crt-list <file>
7726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007727 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7728 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007729
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007730 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007731
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007732 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7733 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7734 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7735 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7736 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7737 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7738 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7739 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007740
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007741defer-accept
7742 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7743 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7744 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7745 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7746 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7747 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7748 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7749 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7750 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7751 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7752 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7753
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007754force-sslv3
7755 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7756 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7757 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7758
7759force-tlsv10
7760 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7761 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7762
7763force-tlsv11
7764 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7765 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7766
7767force-tlsv12
7768 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7769 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007771gid <gid>
7772 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7773 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7774 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7775 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7776 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7777
7778group <group>
7779 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7780 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7781 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7782 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7783 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7784
7785id <id>
7786 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7787 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7788 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7789 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7790
7791interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007792 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7793 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7794 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7795 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7796 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7797 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7798 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007799
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007800level <level>
7801 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7802 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7803 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7804 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7805 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7806 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7807 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7808 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7809 counters).
7810 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7811 all counters).
7812
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007813maxconn <maxconn>
7814 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7815 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7816 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7817 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7818 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7819 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7820 eat all memory.
7821
7822mode <mode>
7823 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7824 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7825 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7826 UNIX sockets.
7827
7828mss <maxseg>
7829 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7830 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7831 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7832 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7833 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7834 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7835 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7836 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7837 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7838 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7839 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7840
7841name <name>
7842 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7843 page.
7844
7845nice <nice>
7846 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7847 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7848 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7849 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7850 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7851 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7852 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7853 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7854 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7855 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7856 one for an RDP socket.
7857
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007858no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7860 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7861 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007862 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7863 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007864
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007865no-tls-tickets
7866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7867 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7868 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7869 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7870
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007871no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007873 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7874 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7875 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7876 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007877
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007878no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007880 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7881 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7882 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7883 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007884
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007885no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007887 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7888 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7889 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7890 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007891
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007892npn <protocols>
7893 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7894 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7895 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7896 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007897 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7898 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007900ssl
7901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7902 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7903 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7904 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7905 to deciphered contents.
7906
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007907strict-sni
7908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7909 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7910 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7911 See the "crt" option for more information.
7912
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007913tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007914 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007915 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7916 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7917 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7918 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7919 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7920 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7921 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007922 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7923 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7924 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007926transparent
7927 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7928 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7929 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7930 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7931 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7932 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7933 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7934 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7935 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7936 so check for support with your vendor.
7937
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007938v4v6
7939 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7940 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7941 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7942 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7943 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7944
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007945v6only
7946 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7947 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7948 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007949 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7950 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007951
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007952uid <uid>
7953 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7954 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7955 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7956 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7957 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7958
7959user <user>
7960 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7961 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7962 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7963 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7964 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7965
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007966verify [none|optional|required]
7967 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7968 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7969 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7970 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7971 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007972 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7973 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7974 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7975 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007976
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020079775.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007978------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007980The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7981which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7982arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7983settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7984after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7985Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7986address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007988 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007989 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007991The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007992
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007993addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007994 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7995 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7996 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7997 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7998 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008000 Supported in default-server: No
8001
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008002agent-check
8003 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8004 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8005 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8006 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8007
8008 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8009 e.g. "75%"
8010
8011 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8012 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8013
8014 * The string "drain".
8015
8016 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8017 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8018 persistence.
8019
8020 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8021
8022 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8023
8024 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8025
8026 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8027
8028 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8029
8030 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8031
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008032 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8033 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8034 parameter.
8035
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008036 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8037 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8038
8039 Supported in default-server: No
8040
8041agent-inter <delay>
8042 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8043 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8044
8045 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8046 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8047 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8048 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8049 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8050 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8051 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8052 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8053 of backends use the same servers.
8054
8055 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8056
8057 Supported in default-server: Yes
8058
8059agent-port <port>
8060 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8061
8062 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8063
8064 Supported in default-server: Yes
8065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008066backup
8067 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8068 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8069 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8070 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8071 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8072 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008074 Supported in default-server: No
8075
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008076ca-file <cafile>
8077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8078 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8079 server's certificate.
8080
8081 Supported in default-server: No
8082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083check
8084 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008085 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8086 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8087 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8088 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8089 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8090 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8091 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008092 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8093 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8094 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008096 Supported in default-server: No
8097
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008098check-send-proxy
8099 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8100 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8101 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8102 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8103 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8104 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8105 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8106
8107 Supported in default-server: No
8108
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008109check-ssl
8110 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8111 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8112 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8113 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8114 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8115 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8116 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8117 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8118 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8119
8120 Supported in default-server: No
8121
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008122ciphers <ciphers>
8123 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8124 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8125 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8126 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8127 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8128 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8129 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8130 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8131
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008132 Supported in default-server: No
8133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008134cookie <value>
8135 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8136 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8137 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8138 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8139 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8140 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8141 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008143 Supported in default-server: No
8144
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008145crl-file <crlfile>
8146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8147 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8148 to verify server's certificate.
8149
8150 Supported in default-server: No
8151
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008152crt <cert>
8153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8154 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8155 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8156 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8157 certificate request.
8158
8159 Supported in default-server: No
8160
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008161disabled
8162 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8163 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8164 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8165 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8166 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8167
8168 Supported in default-server: No
8169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008170error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008171 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8172 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8173 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008175 Supported in default-server: Yes
8176
8177 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008179fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008180 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8181 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8182 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008184 Supported in default-server: Yes
8185
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008186force-sslv3
8187 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8188 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8189 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8190
8191 Supported in default-server: No
8192
8193force-tlsv10
8194 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8195 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8196
8197 Supported in default-server: No
8198
8199force-tlsv11
8200 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8201 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8202
8203 Supported in default-server: No
8204
8205force-tlsv12
8206 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8207 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8208
8209 Supported in default-server: No
8210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008211id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008212 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8213 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8214 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008216 Supported in default-server: No
8217
8218inter <delay>
8219fastinter <delay>
8220downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008221 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8222 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8223 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8224 between checks depending on the server state :
8225
8226 Server state | Interval used
8227 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8228 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8229 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8230 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8231 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8232 or yet unchecked. |
8233 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8234 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8235 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008237 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8238 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8239 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8240 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008241 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8242 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8243 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8244 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8245 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008247 Supported in default-server: Yes
8248
8249maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008250 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8251 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8252 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8253 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8254 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8255 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8256 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8257 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008259 Supported in default-server: Yes
8260
8261maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008262 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8263 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8264 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8265 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8266 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8267 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8268 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008270 Supported in default-server: Yes
8271
8272minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008273 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8274 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8275 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8276 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8277 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8278 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008279 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008280 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008282 Supported in default-server: Yes
8283
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008284no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008285 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8286 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008287 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008288
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008289 Supported in default-server: No
8290
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008291no-tls-tickets
8292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8293 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8294 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8295 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8296
8297 Supported in default-server: No
8298
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008299no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008300 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008301 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8302 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008303 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8304 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008305
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008306 Supported in default-server: No
8307
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008308no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008309 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008310 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8311 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008312 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8313 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008314
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008315 Supported in default-server: No
8316
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008317no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008318 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008319 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8320 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008321 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8322 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008323
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008324 Supported in default-server: No
8325
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008326non-stick
8327 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8328 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8329 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8330
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008331 Supported in default-server: No
8332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008333observe <mode>
8334 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8335 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8336 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8337 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8338 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8339 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008340 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008342 Supported in default-server: No
8343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008344 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008346on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008347 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8348 Currently, four modes are available:
8349 - fastinter: force fastinter
8350 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8351 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8352 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8353 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008355 Supported in default-server: Yes
8356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008357 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8358
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008359on-marked-down <action>
8360 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8361 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008362 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8363 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8364 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8365 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8366 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8367 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8368 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8369 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008370
8371 Actions are disabled by default
8372
8373 Supported in default-server: Yes
8374
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008375on-marked-up <action>
8376 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8377 Currently one action is available:
8378 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8379 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8380 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8381 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8382 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8383 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8384 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8385 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8386
8387 Actions are disabled by default
8388
8389 Supported in default-server: Yes
8390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008391port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008392 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8393 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8394 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8395 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8396 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8397 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008399 Supported in default-server: Yes
8400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008401redir <prefix>
8402 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8403 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8404 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8405 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8406 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8407 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8408 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8409 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008410 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008411 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8412 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8413 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8414 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8415 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8416
8417 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008419 Supported in default-server: No
8420
8421rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008422 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8423 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8424 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008426 Supported in default-server: Yes
8427
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008428send-proxy
8429 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8430 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8431 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8432 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8433 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8434 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8435 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8436 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8437 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008438 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8439 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8440 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8441 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8442 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008443
8444 Supported in default-server: No
8445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008446slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008447 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8448 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8449 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8450 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8451 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8452 parameters :
8453
8454 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8455 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8456
8457 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8458 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8459 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8460 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8461
8462 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8463 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8464 seen as failed.
8465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008466 Supported in default-server: Yes
8467
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008468source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008469source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008470source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008471 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8472 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8473 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8474 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8475
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008476 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8477 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8478 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8479 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8480 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8481 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8482 server.
8483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008484 Supported in default-server: No
8485
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008486ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008487 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8488 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8489 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8490 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8491 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8492 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8493 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008494
8495 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008497track [<proxy>/]<server>
8498 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8499 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8500 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8501 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8502 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008504 Supported in default-server: No
8505
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008506verify [none|required]
8507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8508 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8509 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8510 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008511 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8512 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8513 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008514
8515 Supported in default-server: No
8516
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008517verifyhost <hostname>
8518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8519 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8520 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8521 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8522 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8523 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8524
8525 Supported in default-server: No
8526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008527weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008528 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8529 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8530 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008531 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8532 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8533 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8534 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8535 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8536 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008538 Supported in default-server: Yes
8539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008540
85416. HTTP header manipulation
8542---------------------------
8543
8544In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8545response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8546request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8547which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8548against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8549to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8550passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8551headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8552never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8553
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008554There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8555(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8556rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8557messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8558in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008559happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008560add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8561normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008563This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8564in section 4.2 :
8565
8566 - reqadd <string>
8567 - reqallow <search>
8568 - reqiallow <search>
8569 - reqdel <search>
8570 - reqidel <search>
8571 - reqdeny <search>
8572 - reqideny <search>
8573 - reqpass <search>
8574 - reqipass <search>
8575 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8576 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8577 - reqtarpit <search>
8578 - reqitarpit <search>
8579 - rspadd <string>
8580 - rspdel <search>
8581 - rspidel <search>
8582 - rspdeny <search>
8583 - rspideny <search>
8584 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8585 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8586
8587With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8588is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8589parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8590prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8591Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8592
8593 \t for a tab
8594 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8595 \n for a new line (LF)
8596 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8597 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8598 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8599 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8600 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8601
8602The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8603portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8604above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8605regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
86069 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8607is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8608
8609The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8610after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8611
8612Notes related to these keywords :
8613---------------------------------
8614 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8615 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8616 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8617
8618 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8619 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8620 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8621
8622 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8623 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8624 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8625 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8626 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8627
8628 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8629 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8630 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8631 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8632 useless headers before adding new ones.
8633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008634 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008635 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8636
8637 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8638 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8639 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8640
8641 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8642 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008643 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008644
8645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086467. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8647----------------------------------
8648
8649Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8650client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8651The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8652these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8653but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8654data called patterns.
8655
8656
86577.1. ACL basics
8658---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008659
8660The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8661content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8662from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8663simple :
8664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008665 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008666 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008667 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8668 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008670The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8671adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008672
8673In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008675 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008676
8677This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8678Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8679and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008680an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8681conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8682as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8683are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008684
8685ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8686'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8687which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8688
8689There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8690performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008692The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8693specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8694this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008695methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8696ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008697
8698Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8699 - boolean
8700 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8701 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8702 - string
8703 - data block
8704
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008705Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8706converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8707would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8708The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8709which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008711The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8712 - boolean
8713 - integer or integer range
8714 - IP address / network
8715 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8716 - regular expression
8717 - hex block
8718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008719The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8720
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008721 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8722 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008723 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008724 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008726The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8727read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8728if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8729lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8730will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8731beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8732a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8733lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8734exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8735
8736Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8737loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8738
8739 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8740
8741In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8742the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8743case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8744as well.
8745
8746The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8747sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8748do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8749methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8750is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8751obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8752followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8753default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8754that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8755string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8756
8757There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8758sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8759be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008760
8761 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8762 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008763 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8764 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8765 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8766 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008767
8768 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8769 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008770 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008771
8772 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008773 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008774
8775 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008776 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008777
8778 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8779 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8780
8781 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8782 binary or string samples.
8783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008784 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8785 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008787 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8788 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8789 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008791 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8792 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008794 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8795 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008797 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8798 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008800 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8801 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008802 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008804 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8805 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8806 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008807
8808For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8809request, it is possible to do :
8810
8811 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8812
8813In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8814buffer, one would use the following acl :
8815
8816 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8817
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008818On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8819possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8820
8821 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008823All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8824criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8825method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8826to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8827criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8828the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008830If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8831the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8832example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008834 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8835 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8836 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8837 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008838
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008839
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008840The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008841and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8842combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8843the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008845 +-------------------------------------------------+
8846 | Input sample type |
8847 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8848 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8849 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8850 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8851 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008852 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008853 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008854 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008855 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008856 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008857 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008858 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008859 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008860 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008861 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008862 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008863 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008864 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008865 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008866 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008867 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008868 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008869 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008870 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008871 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008872 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008873 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8874 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008876
8877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088787.1.1. Matching booleans
8879------------------------
8880
8881In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8882Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8883When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8884that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8885
8886Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8887return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8888"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8889
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088917.1.2. Matching integers
8892------------------------
8893
8894Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8895enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8896to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8897
8898Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8899matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8900lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008901
8902For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8903unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8904representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8905
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008906As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8907two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8908instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8909ranges and operators.
8910
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008911For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008912operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8913Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8914of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008916Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008917
8918 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8919 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8920 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8921 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8922 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8923
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008924For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008925
8926 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8927
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008928This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8929
8930 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089337.1.3. Matching strings
8934-----------------------
8935
8936String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8937different forms :
8938
8939 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8940 patterns ;
8941
8942 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8943 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8944
8945 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8946 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8947
8948 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8949 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8950
8951 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8952 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8953 matches.
8954
8955 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8956 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8957 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008958
8959String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8960exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8961characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8962string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8963to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008964before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008965
8966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8968---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008969
8970Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8971they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8972possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8973passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8974the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008975the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8976match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008977
8978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8980-------------------------------------
8981
8982It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8983not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8984a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8985to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8986digits may be used upper or lower case.
8987
8988Example :
8989 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8990 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8991
8992
89937.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8994---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008995
8996IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8997netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8998within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008999host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009000difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9001at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9002does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9003parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009004
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009005IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9006Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9007trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9008IPv6 patterns.
9009
9010HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9011following situations :
9012 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9013 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9014 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9015 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9016 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9017 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9018 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9019 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9020 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9021 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009023
90247.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9025----------------------------------
9026
9027Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9028combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9029
9030 - AND (implicit)
9031 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9032 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009034A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009036 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009038Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9039indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009041For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9042"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9043requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9044is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9045
9046 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9047 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9048 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9049 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9050
9051To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9052and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9053
9054 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9055 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9056 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9057 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9058
9059 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9060 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9061 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9062 use_backend www if host_www
9063
9064It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9065expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9066be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9067the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9068
9069 The following rule :
9070
9071 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9072 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9073
9074 Can also be written that way :
9075
9076 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9077
9078It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9079to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9080simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9081sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9082good use is the following :
9083
9084 With named ACLs :
9085
9086 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9087 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9088 monitor fail if site_dead
9089
9090 With anonymous ACLs :
9091
9092 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9093
9094See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9095
9096
90977.3. Fetching samples
9098---------------------
9099
9100Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9101against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9102sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9103ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9104of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9105available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9106
9107This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9108Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9109compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9110deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9111
9112The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9113matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9114method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9115indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9116
9117As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9118when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9119mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9120the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9121ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9122
9123Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9124multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9125when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9126incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9127are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9128is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9129all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9130
9131Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9132 - name
9133 - name(arg1)
9134 - name(arg1,arg2)
9135
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009136Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9137of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9138is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9139was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9140has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9141unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9142
9143These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9144sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9145the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9146support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009148The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009150 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9151 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9152 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009154 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9155 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9156 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009158 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9159 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9160 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9161 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9162 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9163
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009164 http_date([<offset>])
9165 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9166 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9167 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9168 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9169 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9170 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9171 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9172 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009173
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009174 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9175 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9176 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9177 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9178 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9179 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9180 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9181 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9182 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9183 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9184 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9185 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9186 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9187 the map* converters.
9188
9189 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9190 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9191 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9192 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9193
9194 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9195 | `-_ out | | | |
9196 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9197 | / match `-_ | | | |
9198 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9199 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9200 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9201 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9202 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9203 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9204 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9205 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9206 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9207 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9208
9209 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9210 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9211 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9212 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9213 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9214 trailing spaces/tabs.
9215
9216 Example :
9217
9218 # this is a comment and is ignored
9219 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9220 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9221 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9222 | | | `----------- value
9223 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9224 | `---------------------------- key
9225 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092277.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9228--------------------------------------------
9229
9230A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9231not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9232"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9233The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9234
9235always_false : boolean
9236 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9237 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9238
9239always_true : boolean
9240 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9241 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9242
9243avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009244 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009245 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9246 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9247 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9248 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9249 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9250 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9251 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9252 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9253 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9254 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9255 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9256 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9257 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009259be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009260 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9261 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9262 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9263 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9264 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009266be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9268 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9269 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9270 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9271 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9272 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009273
9274 Example :
9275 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9276 backend dynamic
9277 mode http
9278 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9279 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009281connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9282 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9283 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9284 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9285 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009286
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009287 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009288 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009289 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009291 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9292 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009293
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009294 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009295 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009296 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009297 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9298 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009299 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009300 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009301
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009302 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9303 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009304 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009305 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009306
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009307date([<offset>]) : integer
9308 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9309 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9310 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9311 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009312 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9313
9314 Example :
9315
9316 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9317 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009318
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009319env(<name>) : string
9320 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9321 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9322 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9323 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9324 certain way.
9325
9326 Examples :
9327 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9328 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9329
9330 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9331 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009333fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9334 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009335 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9336 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009337 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9338 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9339 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9340 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9341 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009343fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9344 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9345 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9346 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9347 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9348 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9349 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9350 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9351 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009352
9353 Example :
9354 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9355 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9356 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9357 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9358 frontend mail
9359 bind :25
9360 mode tcp
9361 maxconn 100
9362 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9363 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9364 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9365 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9369 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9370 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009371 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9372 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9373 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009375queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009376 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9377 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9378 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009379 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9380 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9381 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9382 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9383 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9384
9385srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9387 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9388 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9389 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9390 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9391 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9392 methods.
9393
9394srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9395 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9396 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9397 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9398 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9399 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9400 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9401 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9402
9403srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9404 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9405 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9406 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9407 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9408 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9409 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9410 overloading servers).
9411
9412 Example :
9413 # Redirect to a separate back
9414 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9415 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9416 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9417
9418table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9419 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9420 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9421
9422table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9423 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9424 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9425 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9426
9427
94287.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9429----------------------------------
9430
9431The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9432closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9433methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9434sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9435TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009436the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9437counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9438"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009439argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9440the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9441this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009442
9443be_id : integer
9444 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9445 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9446
9447dst : ip
9448 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9449 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9450 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9451 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9452 RFC 4291.
9453
9454dst_conn : integer
9455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9456 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9457 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9458 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9459 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9460 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9461 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9462 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009464dst_port : integer
9465 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9466 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9467 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9468 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9469 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9470 an HTTP header.
9471
9472fe_id : integer
9473 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9474 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9475 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9476
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009477sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9478sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9479sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9480sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009481 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9482 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9483 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9484
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009485sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9486sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9487sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9488sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009489 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9490 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9491 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9492
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009493sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9494sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9495sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9496sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009497 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9498 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009499 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9500 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9501 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009502
9503 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9504 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009505 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9506 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9507 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009508 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9509 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9510
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009511sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9512sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9513sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9514sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009515 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9516 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9517
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009518sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9519sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9520sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9521sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9523 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9524 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9525
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009526sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9527sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9528sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9529sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009530 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9531 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9532 See also src_conn_rate.
9533
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009534sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9535sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9536sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9537sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009538 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009539 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009540
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009541sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9542sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9543sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9544sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009545 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9546 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9547 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009548 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9549 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9550 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009551
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009552sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9553sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9554sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9555sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009556 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9557 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9558 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9559
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009560sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9561sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9562sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9563sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009564 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9565 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9566 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9567 src_http_err_rate.
9568
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009569sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9570sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9571sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9572sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009573 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9574 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9575 src_http_req_cnt.
9576
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009577sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9578sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9579sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9580sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009581 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9582 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9583 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9584 src_http_req_rate.
9585
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009586sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9587sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9588sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9589sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009590 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009591 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9592 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9593 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9594 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009595
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009596 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9597 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009598 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9599
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009600sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9601sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9602sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9603sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009604 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9605 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9606 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9607 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9608
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009609sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9610sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9611sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9612sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009613 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9614 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9615 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9616 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9617
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009618sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9619sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9620sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9621sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009622 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9623 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9624 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9625 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009626 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009627 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9628
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009629sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9630sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9631sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9632sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009633 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9634 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9635 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9636 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9637 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009638 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009639
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009640sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9641sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9642sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9643sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009644 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9645 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9646 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9647
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009648sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9649sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9650sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9651sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009652 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9653 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009654 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009655 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9656 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9658 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9659 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009661so_id : integer
9662 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9663 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9664 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009666src : ip
9667 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9668 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9669 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9670 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9671 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9672 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9673 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009674
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009675 Example:
9676 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9677 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9680 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9681 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9682 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009683 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009685src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9686 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9687 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009688 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009689 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9692 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9693 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9694 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9695 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9696 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9697 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009698
9699 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9700 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9701 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9702 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009703 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009704 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9705 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009707src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009708 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009709 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009710 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009711 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009713src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009714 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009715 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9716 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009717 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009719src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9720 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9721 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9722 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009723 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009725src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009726 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009727 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009728 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009729 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009731src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009732 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009733 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009734 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9735 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009736 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9737 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9738 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009740src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9741 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9742 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009743 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009744 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009745 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009747src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9748 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9749 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9750 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9751 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009752 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9755 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9756 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9757 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009758 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009760src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9761 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9762 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9763 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009764 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009765 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009767src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9768 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9769 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9770 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009771 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009772 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9773 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009774
9775 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009776 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009777 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009779src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9780 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9781 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9782 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9783 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009784 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9785 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009787src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9788 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9789 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009790 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9791 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009792 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009794src_port : integer
9795 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9796 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9797 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9798 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009800src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9801 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009802 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9803 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9804 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009805 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009807src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9808 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9809 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9810 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9811 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009812 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009814src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9815 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9816 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9817 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9818 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9819 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9820 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9821 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9822 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009823
9824 Example :
9825 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9826 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9827 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9828 listen ssh
9829 bind :22
9830 mode tcp
9831 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009832 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009834 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009836srv_id : integer
9837 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9838 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9839 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009840
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098427.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9843----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009845The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9846closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9847when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9848usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9849future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009851ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9852 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9853 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9854 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9855 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9856 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009858ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9859 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9860 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9861 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9862 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009864ssl_c_err : integer
9865 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9866 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9867 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9868 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9869 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9872 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9873 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9874 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9875 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9876 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9877 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9878 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9879 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009881 ACL derivatives :
9882 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009884ssl_c_key_alg : string
9885 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9886 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9887 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009889 ACL derivatives :
9890 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009892ssl_c_notafter : string
9893 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9894 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9895 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897 ACL derivatives :
9898 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009900ssl_c_notbefore : string
9901 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9902 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9903 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009905 ACL derivatives :
9906 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9909 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9910 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9911 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9912 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9913 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9914 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9915 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9916 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009918 ACL derivatives :
9919 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921ssl_c_serial : binary
9922 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9923 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9924 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926 ACL derivatives :
9927 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009929ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9930 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9931 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9932 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009934ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9935 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9936 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9937 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939 ACL derivatives :
9940 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9941
9942ssl_c_used : boolean
9943 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9944 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946ssl_c_verify : integer
9947 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9948 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9949 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9950 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952ssl_c_version : integer
9953 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9954 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009956ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9957 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9958 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9959 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9960 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009961 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009962 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9963 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9964 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009966 ACL derivatives :
9967 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009969ssl_f_key_alg : string
9970 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9971 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9972 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974 ACL derivatives :
9975 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009977ssl_f_notafter : string
9978 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9979 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9980 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982 ACL derivatives :
9983 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985ssl_f_notbefore : string
9986 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9987 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9988 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990 ACL derivatives :
9991 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009993ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9994 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9995 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9996 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9997 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9998 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9999 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10000 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10001 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003 ACL derivatives :
10004 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006ssl_f_serial : binary
10007 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10008 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10009 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010011 ACL derivatives :
10012 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010014ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10015 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10016 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10017 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019 ACL derivatives :
10020 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010022ssl_f_version : integer
10023 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10024 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10025
10026ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010027 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10028 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10029 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010031 Example :
10032 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10033 listen http-https
10034 bind :80
10035 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10036 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10037
10038ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10039 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10040 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10041
10042ssl_fc_alpn : string
10043 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10044 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10045 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10046 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10047 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10048 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10049 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10050 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10051 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10052
10053 ACL derivatives :
10054 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010056ssl_fc_cipher : string
10057 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10058 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010060 ACL derivatives :
10061 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010063ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010064 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10065 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010066 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10067 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10068 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10069 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010071ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10072 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010073 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10074 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10075 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10076 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010078ssl_fc_npn : string
10079 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10080 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10081 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10082 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10083 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10084 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10085 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10086 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088 ACL derivatives :
10089 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010091ssl_fc_protocol : string
10092 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10093 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010095 ACL derivatives :
10096 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10097
10098ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10099 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10100 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10101 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10102 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104ssl_fc_sni : string
10105 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10106 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10107 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10108 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10109 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10110
10111 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10112 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10113 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010114 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10115 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010117 ACL derivatives :
10118 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10119 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10120 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10123 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10124 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010125
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101277.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10128------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010130Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10131sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10132only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10133For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10134be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10135can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10136sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10137for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10138content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010140payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10141 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10142 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10143 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010145payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10146 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10147 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10148 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010150req.len : integer
10151req_len : integer (deprecated)
10152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10153 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10154 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10155 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10156 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10157 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10158 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10159 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10162 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010163 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10164 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10165 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10166 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010168 ACL alternatives :
10169 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010171req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10172 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10173 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10174 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10175 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177 ACL alternatives :
10178 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010180 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182req.proto_http : boolean
10183req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10184 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10185 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10186 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10187 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10188 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10189 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10190 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010192 Example:
10193 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10194 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10195 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010196 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10199rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10200 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10201 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10202 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10203 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10204 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10205 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10206 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010208 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10209 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10210 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10211 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10212 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10213 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010215 ACL derivatives :
10216 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218 Example :
10219 listen tse-farm
10220 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10221 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10222 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10223 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10224 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10225 persist rdp-cookie
10226 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10227 # This is only useful makes sense if
10228 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10229 stick-table type string size 204800
10230 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10231 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10232 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010234 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10235 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010237req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10238rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10239 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10240 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10241 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10242 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244 ACL derivatives :
10245 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010247req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10248req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10249 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10250 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10251 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10252 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10253 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10254 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10255 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257req.ssl_sni : string
10258req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10259 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10260 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10261 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10262 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10263 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10264 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10265 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10266 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10267 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10268 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10269 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10270 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272 ACL derivatives :
10273 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275 Examples :
10276 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10277 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10278 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10279 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10280 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10283rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10284 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10285 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10286 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10287 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10288 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10289 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10290 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010292req.ssl_ver : integer
10293req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10294 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10295 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10296 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10297 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10298 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10299 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10300 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10301 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10302 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304 ACL derivatives :
10305 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010306
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010307res.len : integer
10308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10309 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10310 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10311 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10312 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10313 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10314 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10315 content inspection.
10316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10318 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010319 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10320 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10321 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10322 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010324res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10325 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10326 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10327 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10328 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010332wait_end : boolean
10333 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10334 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10335 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10336 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10337 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10338 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10339 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10340 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342 Examples :
10343 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10344 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10345 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010347 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10348 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10349 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10350 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10351 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10352 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10353 tcp-request content reject
10354
10355
103567.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10357--------------------------------------
10358
10359It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10360This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10361data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10362its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10363HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10364content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10365to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10366more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10367response are indexed.
10368
10369base : string
10370 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10371 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10372 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10373 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10374 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10375 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10376 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10377 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10378
10379 ACL derivatives :
10380 base : exact string match
10381 base_beg : prefix match
10382 base_dir : subdir match
10383 base_dom : domain match
10384 base_end : suffix match
10385 base_len : length match
10386 base_reg : regex match
10387 base_sub : substring match
10388
10389base32 : integer
10390 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10391 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10392 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10393 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10394
10395base32+src : binary
10396 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10397 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10398 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10399 per-URL counters.
10400
10401req.cook([<name>]) : string
10402cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10403 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10404 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10405 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10406 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10407 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10408 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10409 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10410 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10411
10412 ACL derivatives :
10413 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10414 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10415 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10416 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10417 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10418 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10419 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10420 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010422req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10423cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10424 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10425 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010427req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10428cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10429 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10430 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10431 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10432 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010434cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10435 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10436 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10437 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10438 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10439 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10440 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10441 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10442 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10443 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10444 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010446hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10447 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10448 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10449 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10450 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10451 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010453req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10454 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10455 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10456 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10457 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10458 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10459 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10460 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10461 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010463req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10464 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10465 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10466 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10467 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10470 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10471 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10472 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10473 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10474 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10475 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10476 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10477 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10478 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10479 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10480 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482 ACL derivatives :
10483 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10484 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10485 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10486 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10487 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10488 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10489 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10490 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10491
10492req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10493hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10494 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10495 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10496 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10497 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10498 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10499 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10500 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10501 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10502 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10503
10504req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10505hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10506 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10507 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10508 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10509 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10510 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10511 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10512 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10513 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10514
10515req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10516hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10517 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10518 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10519 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10520 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10521 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10522 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10523 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10524
10525http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10526 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10527 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10528 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10529 basic auth is supported.
10530
10531http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10532 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10533 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10534 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10535 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10536 basic auth is supported.
10537
10538 ACL derivatives :
10539 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10540
10541http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010542 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10543 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10545 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010547method : integer + string
10548 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10549 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10550 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10551 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10552 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10553 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10554 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556 ACL derivatives :
10557 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010559 Example :
10560 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10561 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10562 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010564path : string
10565 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10566 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10567 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10568 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10569 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10570 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10571 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573 ACL derivatives :
10574 path : exact string match
10575 path_beg : prefix match
10576 path_dir : subdir match
10577 path_dom : domain match
10578 path_end : suffix match
10579 path_len : length match
10580 path_reg : regex match
10581 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010583req.ver : string
10584req_ver : string (deprecated)
10585 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10586 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10587 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589 ACL derivatives :
10590 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010592res.comp : boolean
10593 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10594 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10595 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010597res.comp_algo : string
10598 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10599 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10600 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602res.cook([<name>]) : string
10603scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10604 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10605 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10606 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608 ACL derivatives :
10609 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10612scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10613 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10614 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10615 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10618scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10619 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10620 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10621 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010623res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10624 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10625 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10626 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10627 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10628 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10629 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10630 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10631 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10632 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10635 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10636 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10637 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10638 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10639 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10642shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10643 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10644 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10645 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10646 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10647 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10648 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10649 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10650 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010652 ACL derivatives :
10653 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10654 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10655 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10656 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10657 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10658 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10659 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10660 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10661
10662res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10663shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10664 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10665 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10666 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10667 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10668 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010670res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10671shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10672 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10673 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10674 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10675 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10676 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10677 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010679res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10680shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10681 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10682 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10683 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10684 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10685 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10686 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010688res.ver : string
10689resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10690 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10691 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010693 ACL derivatives :
10694 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10697 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10698 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10699 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10700 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010702 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10703 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010705 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010707status : integer
10708 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10709 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10710 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010712url : string
10713 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10714 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10715 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10716 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10717 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10718 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10719 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721 ACL derivatives :
10722 url : exact string match
10723 url_beg : prefix match
10724 url_dir : subdir match
10725 url_dom : domain match
10726 url_end : suffix match
10727 url_len : length match
10728 url_reg : regex match
10729 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010731url_ip : ip
10732 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10733 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10734 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10735 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10736 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10737 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10738 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740url_port : integer
10741 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10742 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10743 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10744 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010746urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10747url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10748 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10749 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10750 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10751 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10752 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10753 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10754 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10755 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10756 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010758 ACL derivatives :
10759 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10760 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10761 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10762 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10763 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10764 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10765 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10766 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010767
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769 Example :
10770 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10771 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10772 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10773 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10776 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10777 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10778 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010779
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107817.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010782---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010784Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10785every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010786order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010788ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10789---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010790FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010791HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010792HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10793HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010794HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10795HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10796HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10797HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10798LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010799METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10800METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10801METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10802METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10803METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10804METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010805RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010806REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010808WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10809---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010810
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108128. Logging
10813----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010814
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010815One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10816provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10817very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10818provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10819state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010820to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010821headers.
10822
10823In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10824about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10825send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10826
10827 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10828 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10829 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10830 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10831 at the termination.
10832
10833The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10834allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10835as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10836while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10837real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10838delay.
10839
10840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108418.1. Log levels
10842---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010843
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010844TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010845source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010846HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10847in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10848track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10849syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10850about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010851
10852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108538.2. Log formats
10854----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010855
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010856HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010857and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10858slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10859options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010860
10861 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10862 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10863 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10864 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10865 extents.
10866
10867 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10868 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10869 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10870 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10871 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10872
10873 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10874 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10875 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10876 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10877 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10878
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010879 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10880 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10881 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10882 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10883
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010884 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10885
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010886Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10887specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10888field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10889servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10890always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10891identifier.
10892
10893Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10894 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10895 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10896 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10897 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10898
10899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109008.2.1. Default log format
10901-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010902
10903This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10904as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10905format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10906
10907 Example :
10908 listen www
10909 mode http
10910 log global
10911 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10912
10913 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10914 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10915 (www/HTTP)
10916
10917 Field Format Extract from the example above
10918 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10919 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10920 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10921 4 'to' to
10922 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10923 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10924
10925Detailed fields description :
10926 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10927 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10928 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10929 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10930 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10931 and processed the connection.
10932 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10933
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010934In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10935"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10936connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010938It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10939will eventually disappear.
10940
10941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109428.2.2. TCP log format
10943---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010944
10945The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10946is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10947information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10948counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10949emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10950environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10951the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10952sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010953specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10954not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10955fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10956marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010957
10958 Example :
10959 frontend fnt
10960 mode tcp
10961 option tcplog
10962 log global
10963 default_backend bck
10964
10965 backend bck
10966 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10967
10968 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10969 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10970 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10971
10972 Field Format Extract from the example above
10973 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10974 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10975 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10976 4 frontend_name fnt
10977 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10978 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10979 7 bytes_read* 212
10980 8 termination_state --
10981 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10982 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10983
10984Detailed fields description :
10985 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010986 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10987 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10988 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10989 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10990 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010991
10992 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010993 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10994 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10995 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010996
10997 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10998 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10999 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11000 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11001
11002 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11003 and processed the connection.
11004
11005 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11006 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11007 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11008 applications.
11009
11010 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11011 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11012 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11013 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11014 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11015
11016 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11017 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11018 See "Timers" below for more details.
11019
11020 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11021 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11022 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11023 "Timers" below for more details.
11024
11025 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11026 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11027 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11028 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11029 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11030 details.
11031
11032 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11033 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11034 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11035 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11036 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11037
11038 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11039 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11040 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11041 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11042 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11043 for more details.
11044
11045 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011046 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011047 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11048 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11049 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011050 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011051
11052 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11053 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11054 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11055 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11056 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11057 caused by a denial of service attack.
11058
11059 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11060 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11061 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11062 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11063 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11064 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11065 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11066 denial of service attack.
11067
11068 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11069 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11070 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11071 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11072 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11073 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11074 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11075 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11076 be processed than on other servers.
11077
11078 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11079 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11080 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11081 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11082 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11083 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11084 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11085 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11086 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11087 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11088 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11089 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11090 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11091
11092 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11093 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11094 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11095 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11096 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11097 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11098 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11099 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11100
11101 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11102 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11103 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11104 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11105 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11106 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11107 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11108 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11109 occurs.
11110
11111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111128.2.3. HTTP log format
11113----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011114
11115The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11116is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11117the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11118are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11119emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11120generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11121"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11122which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011123frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11124is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011125
11126Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11127slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11128with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11129
11130 Example :
11131 frontend http-in
11132 mode http
11133 option httplog
11134 log global
11135 default_backend bck
11136
11137 backend static
11138 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11139
11140 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11141 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11142 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011143 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011144
11145 Field Format Extract from the example above
11146 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11147 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11148 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11149 4 frontend_name http-in
11150 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11151 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11152 7 status_code 200
11153 8 bytes_read* 2750
11154 9 captured_request_cookie -
11155 10 captured_response_cookie -
11156 11 termination_state ----
11157 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11158 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11159 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11160 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11161 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011162
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011163
11164Detailed fields description :
11165 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011166 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11167 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11168 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11169 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11170 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011171
11172 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011173 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11174 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11175 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011176
11177 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11178 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11179 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11180 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11181 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11182
11183 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11184 and processed the connection.
11185
11186 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11187 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11188 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11189
11190 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11191 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11192 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11193 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11194 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11195 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11196
11197 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11198 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11199 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11200 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11201 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11202 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11203
11204 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11205 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11206 See "Timers" below for more details.
11207
11208 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11209 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11210 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11211 below for more details.
11212
11213 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11214 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11215 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11216 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11217 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11218 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11219 for more details.
11220
11221 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11222 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11223 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11224 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11225 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11226 details.
11227
11228 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11229 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11230 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11231
11232 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11233 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11234 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11235 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11236 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11237 overflowing.
11238
11239 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11240 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11241 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11242 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11243 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11244 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11245 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11246 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11247
11248 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11249 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11250 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11251 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11252 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11253 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11254 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11255 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11256
11257 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11258 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11259 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11260 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11261 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11262 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11263 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11264
11265 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011266 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011267 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11268 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11269 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011270 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011271 system.
11272
11273 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11274 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11275 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11276 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11277 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11278 caused by a denial of service attack.
11279
11280 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11281 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11282 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11283 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11284 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11285 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11286 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11287 denial of service attack.
11288
11289 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11290 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11291 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11292 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11293 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11294 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11295 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11296 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11297 processed than on other servers.
11298
11299 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11300 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11301 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11302 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11303 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11304 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11305 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11306 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11307 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11308 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11309 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11310 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11311 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11312
11313 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11314 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11315 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11316 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11317 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11318 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11319 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11320 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11321
11322 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11323 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11324 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11325 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11326 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11327 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11328 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11329 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11330 occurs.
11331
11332 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11333 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11334 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11335 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11336 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11337 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11338 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11339 cookies" below for more details.
11340
11341 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11342 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11343 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11344 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11345 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11346 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11347 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11348 and cookies" below for more details.
11349
11350 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11351 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11352 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11353 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11354 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11355 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11356 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11357 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11358
11359
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200113608.2.4. Custom log format
11361------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011362
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011363The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011364mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011365
11366HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11367Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11368separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11369prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11370
11371Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11372variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11373string formats ("Q").
11374
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011375If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011376as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011377less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11378the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11379
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011380Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011381In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11382in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011383
11384Flags are :
11385 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011386 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011387
11388 Example:
11389
11390 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11391 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11392
11393At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11394
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011395 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11396 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011397
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011398the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011399
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011400 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011401 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011402 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011403
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011404and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11405
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011406 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011407 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11408
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011409Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11410
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011411 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011412 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011413 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11414 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11415 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011416 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11417 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11418 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011419 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011420 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011421 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011422 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011423 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011424 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011425 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11426 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011427 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011428 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11429 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011430 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011431 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11432 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011433 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11434 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11435 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011436 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011437 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11438 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011439 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011440 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11441 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11442 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011443 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011444 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11445 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11446 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11447 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011448 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011449 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011450 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011451 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011452 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011453 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011454 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11455 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11456 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011457 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011458 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11459 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011460 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011461 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011462 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011463 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011464
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011465 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011466
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011467
114688.2.5. Error log format
11469-----------------------
11470
11471When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11472protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11473By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11474"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11475will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11476logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11477
11478The format looks like this :
11479
11480 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11481 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11482 Connection error during SSL handshake
11483
11484 Field Format Extract from the example above
11485 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11486 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11487 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11488 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11489 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11490
11491These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11492failures.
11493
11494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114958.3. Advanced logging options
11496-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011497
11498Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11499just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11500options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11501for more information about their usage.
11502
11503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11505------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011506
11507It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11508haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11509commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11510monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11511ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11512
11513 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11514 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11515 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11516 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11517
11518 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11519 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11520 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11521 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11522 such as other load-balancers.
11523
11524 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11525 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11526 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11527
11528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115298.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11530----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011531
11532The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11533what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11534or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11535"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11536just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11537log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11538after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11539is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11540with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11541with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11542
11543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115448.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11545------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011546
11547Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11548for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11549"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11550retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11551raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11552a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11553file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11554you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11555"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11556
11557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115588.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11559--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011560
11561Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11562multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11563them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11564"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11565logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11566error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11567and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11568too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11569useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11570alternative.
11571
11572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115738.4. Timing events
11574------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011575
11576Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11577reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11578the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11579frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11580mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11581
11582 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11583 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11584 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11585 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11586 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11587
11588 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11589 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11590 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11591 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11592 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11593
11594 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11595 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11596 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11597 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11598 connection never established.
11599
11600 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11601 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11602 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11603 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11604 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11605 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11606 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11607 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11608 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11609 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11610 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11611
11612 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11613 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11614 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11615 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11616 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11617
11618 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11619
11620 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11621 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11622 negative.
11623
11624These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11625protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11626that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011627due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011628close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11629session has been aborted on timeout.
11630
11631Most common cases :
11632
11633 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11634 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11635 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11636 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11637 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11638 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11639 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11640 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11641 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011642 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11643 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11644 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011645
11646 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11647 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11648 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11649 of ms on remote networks.
11650
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011651 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11652 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11653 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011654
11655 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11656 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11657 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11658 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11659 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11660 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11661 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11662 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11663 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11664 to the server until another one is released.
11665
11666Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11667
11668 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11669 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11670 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11671
11672 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11673 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11674 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11675
11676 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11677 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11678 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11679 flags.
11680
11681 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11682 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11683 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11684 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11685 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11686 the client connection was maintained open.
11687
11688 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11689 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11690 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11691 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11692
11693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116948.5. Session state at disconnection
11695-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011696
11697TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11698"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
116992-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11700each of which has a special meaning :
11701
11702 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11703 session to terminate :
11704
11705 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11706
11707 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11708 server explicitly refused it.
11709
11710 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11711 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11712 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11713 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011714 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11715
11716 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11717 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011718
11719 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11720 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11721 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11722 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11723 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11724
11725 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11726 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11727 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11728 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11729 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11730
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011731 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11732 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11733
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011734 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11735 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11736 backup connections when going up.
11737
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011738 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011740 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11741 send or receive data.
11742
11743 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11744 send or receive data.
11745
11746 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11747 with nothing left in the buffers.
11748
11749 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11750
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011751 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011752 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11753
11754 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11755 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11756 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11757 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11758 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11759
11760 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11761 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11762
11763 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11764 server (HTTP only).
11765
11766 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11767
11768 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11769 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11770 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11771
11772 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11773 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11774 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11775
11776 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11777
11778 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11779 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11780
11781 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11782 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11783 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11784
11785 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11786 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011787 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11788 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011789
11790 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11791 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11792 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11793 another server.
11794
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011795 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011796 server.
11797
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011798 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11799 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11800 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11801 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11802
11803 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11804 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11805 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11806 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11807
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011808 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11809 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11810 "use-server" rule).
11811
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011812 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11813
11814 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11815 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11816
11817 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11818
11819 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11820 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11821 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11822
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011823 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11824 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11825 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11826 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11827 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11828
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011829 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11830
11831 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11832 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11833
11834 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11835
11836 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11837
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011838The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11839was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011840helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11841starvation, attacks, etc...
11842
11843The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11844alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11845easier finding and understanding.
11846
11847 Flags Reason
11848
11849 -- Normal termination.
11850
11851 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11852 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11853 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11854 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11855
11856 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11857 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11858 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11859 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11860 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11861 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011862
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011863 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11864 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011865 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011866
11867 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11868 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11869 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11870
11871 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11872 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11873 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11874 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11875 the server takes too long to respond.
11876
11877 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11878 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11879 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11880 long a time to respond.
11881
11882 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11883 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11884 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11885 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11886 and the client.
11887
11888 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11889 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11890 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11891 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11892 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11893 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11894
11895 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11896 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011897 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11898 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11899 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11900 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011901
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011902 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11903 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011905 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011906 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11907 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11908 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11909 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11910 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11911
11912 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11913 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11914 503 or 504 here.
11915
11916 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11917 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11918 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11919 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11920 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11921
11922 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11923 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011924 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011925 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11926 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11927
11928 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11929 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11930 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11931 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11932 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11933 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11934 between haproxy and the server.
11935
11936 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11937 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11938 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11939 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11940 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11941 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11942 solution is to fix the application.
11943
11944 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11945 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11946 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11947 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11948 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11949 external attacks.
11950
11951 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11952 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011953 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011954 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11955 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11956
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011957 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11958 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11959 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011960 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11961 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011962
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011963 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11964 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11965 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11966 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011967 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11968 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11969 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11970 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11971 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011972
11973 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11974 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11975 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11976 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11977
11978 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11979 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11980 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11981 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11982
11983 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11984 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11985 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11986 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11987
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011988The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11989persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11990important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11991re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11992
11993 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11994
11995 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11996 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11997 set on a GET request.
11998
11999 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12000 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012001 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012002 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12003
12004 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12005 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12006 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12007
12008 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12009 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12010 already got a cookie.
12011
12012 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12013 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12014 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12015 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12016 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12017
12018 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12019 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12020 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12021
12022 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12023 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12024 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12025
12026 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12027 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12028
12029 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12030 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12031 then advertised in the response.
12032
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120348.6. Non-printable characters
12035-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012036
12037In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12038consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12039converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12040prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12041being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12042escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12043is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12044'}' when logging headers.
12045
12046Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12047issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12048containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12049
12050Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12051the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12052performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12053
12054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120558.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12056---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012057
12058Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12059achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012060section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012061cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12062the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12063the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012064locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012065not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12066user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12067a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12068wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12069
12070 Examples :
12071 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12072 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12073
12074 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12075 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12076
12077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120788.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12079---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012080
12081Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12082proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12083the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12084server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12085
12086Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12087response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012088section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012089
12090It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012091time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12092appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012093are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12094and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12095follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12096request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12097in the logs.
12098
12099 Example :
12100 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12101 listen proxy-out
12102 mode http
12103 option httplog
12104 option logasap
12105 log global
12106 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12107
12108 # log the name of the virtual server
12109 capture request header Host len 20
12110
12111 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12112 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12113
12114 # log the beginning of the referrer
12115 capture request header Referer len 20
12116
12117 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12118 capture response header Server len 20
12119
12120 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12121 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12122
12123 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12124 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12125
12126 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12127 capture response header Via len 20
12128
12129 # log the URL location during a redirection
12130 capture response header Location len 20
12131
12132 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12133 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12134 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12135 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12136 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12137
12138 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12139 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12140 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12141 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012142 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012143
12144 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12145 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12146 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12147 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12148 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012149 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012150
12151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121528.9. Examples of logs
12153---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012154
12155These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12156them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12157reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12158
12159 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12160 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12161 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12162
12163 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12164 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12165
12166 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12167 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12168 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12169
12170 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12171 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12172
12173 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12174 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12175 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12176
12177 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012178 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012179 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12180 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12181
12182 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12183 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12184 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12185
12186 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12187 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012188 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012189 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12190 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12191 to return the 502 and not the server.
12192
12193 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012194 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012195
12196 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12197 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12198 Nothing was sent to any server.
12199
12200 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12201 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12202
12203 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12204 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12205 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12206 send a 408 return code to the client.
12207
12208 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12209 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12210
12211 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12212 5 seconds ("c----").
12213
12214 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12215 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012216 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012217
12218 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012219 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012220 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12221 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12222 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12223 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12224 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012225
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122279. Statistics and monitoring
12228----------------------------
12229
12230It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12231mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12232CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12233Unix socket.
12234
12235
122369.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012237---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012238
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012239The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12240page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012242 0. pxname: proxy name
12243 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12244 for server)
12245 2. qcur: current queued requests
12246 3. qmax: max queued requests
12247 4. scur: current sessions
12248 5. smax: max sessions
12249 6. slim: sessions limit
12250 7. stot: total sessions
12251 8. bin: bytes in
12252 9. bout: bytes out
12253 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012254 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012255 12. ereq: request errors
12256 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012257 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012258 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12259 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012260 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012261 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12262 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12263 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12264 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12265 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12266 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12267 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12268 25. qlimit: queue limit
12269 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12270 27. iid: unique proxy id
12271 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12272 29. throttle: warm up status
12273 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12274 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012275 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012276 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12277 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12278 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012279 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012280 UNK -> unknown
12281 INI -> initializing
12282 SOCKERR -> socket error
12283 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12284 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12285 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12286 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12287 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12288 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12289 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12290 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12291 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12292 disable-on-404
12293 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12294 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12295 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012296 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12297 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012298 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12299 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12300 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12301 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12302 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12303 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012304 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12305 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12306 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12307 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012308 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12309 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012310 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12311 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12312 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012313 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012314
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123169.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012317-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012318
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012319The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12320necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12321A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12322issuing commands by hand :
12323
12324 global
12325 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12326 stats timeout 2m
12327
12328It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12329the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12330never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12331situations :
12332
12333 global
12334 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12335 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12336 stats timeout 2m
12337
12338To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12339swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12340to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12341syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12342
12343 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12344 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12345
12346The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12347script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12348for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12349
12350The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12351that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12352editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12353(eg: watch a counter).
12354
12355The socket supports two operation modes :
12356 - interactive
12357 - non-interactive
12358
12359The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12360this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12361sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12362mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12363commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12364example :
12365
12366 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12367
12368The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12369entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12370for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12371sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12372"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12373after processing the last command of the same line.
12374
12375For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12376"prompt" command :
12377
12378 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12379 prompt
12380 > show info
12381 ...
12382 >
12383
12384Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12385delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12386that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12387parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012388
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012389It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12390on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12391own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012392
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012393The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12394If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12395all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12396it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12397
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012398add map <map> <key> <value>
12399 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12400 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12401 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12402
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012403clear counters
12404 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12405 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12406 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12407 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12408 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12409
12410clear counters all
12411 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12412 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12413 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12414
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012415clear map <map>
12416 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12417
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012418clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12419 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12420
12421 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12422 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12423 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12424 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12425 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12426 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12427
12428 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12429
12430 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12431 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12432 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12433 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12434 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12435 the ACLs :
12436
12437 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12438 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12439 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12440 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12441 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12442 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12443
12444 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012445 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12446 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012447
12448 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012449 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012450 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012451 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12452 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12453 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12454 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012455
12456 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12457
12458 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012459 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012460 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12461 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012462 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12463 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12464 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012465
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012466enable agent <backend>/<server>
12467 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12468
12469 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12470 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12471 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12472 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12473 re-enabled using enable agent.
12474
12475 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12476 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12477 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12478 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12479 otherwise unchanged.
12480
12481 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12482 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12483 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12484
12485 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12486 level "admin".
12487
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012488del map <map> <key>
12489 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12490
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012491disable frontend <frontend>
12492 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12493 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12494 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12495 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12496 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12497 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12498 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12499 on the stats page.
12500
12501 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12502 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12503
12504 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12505 level "admin".
12506
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012507disable server <backend>/<server>
12508 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12509 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12510 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12511 during the maintenance.
12512
12513 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12514 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12515
12516 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012517 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012518
12519 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12520 level "admin".
12521
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012522enable agent <backend>/<server>
12523 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12524
12525 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12526 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12527
12528 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12529 level "admin".
12530
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012531enable frontend <frontend>
12532 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12533 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12534 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12535 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12536 which was disabled.
12537
12538 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12539 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12540
12541 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12542 level "admin".
12543
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012544enable server <backend>/<server>
12545 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12546 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12547
12548 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012549 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012550
12551 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12552 level "admin".
12553
12554get weight <backend>/<server>
12555 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12556 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12557 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12558 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12559 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012560 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012561
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012562help
12563 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12564 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012565
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012566prompt
12567 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12568 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12569 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12570 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12571 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12572 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12573 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12574 command.
12575
12576quit
12577 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012578
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012579set map <map> <key> <value>
12580 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12581 is <value>.
12582
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012583set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012584 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12585 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12586 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12587 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12588 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012589 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12590 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12591
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012592set maxconn global <maxconn>
12593 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12594 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12595 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12596 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12597 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12598 setting.
12599
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012600set rate-limit connections global <value>
12601 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12602 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12603 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12604 is passed in number of connections per second.
12605
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012606set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12607 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12608 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012609 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12610 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012611
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012612set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12613 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12614 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12615 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12616 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12617
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012618set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012619 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12620 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12621 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12622 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012623 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12624 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012625
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012626set timeout cli <delay>
12627 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12628 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12629 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12630
12631set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12632 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12633 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012634 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12635 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12636 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12637 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12638 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12639 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12640 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12641 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12642 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12643 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12644 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12645 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12646 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012647
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012648show errors [<iid>]
12649 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12650 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012651 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12652 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12653 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012654
12655 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12656 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12657 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12658 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12659 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12660 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12661 are reported too.
12662
12663 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12664 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12665 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12666 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12667 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12668 code.
12669
12670 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12671 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12672 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12673 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12674 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12675 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12676 line.
12677
12678 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012679 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12680 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012681 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12682 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12683
12684 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12685 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12686 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12687 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12688 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12689 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12690 00204+ minal\r\n
12691 00211 \r\n
12692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012694 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12695 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12696 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12697 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12698 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12699 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012700
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012701show info
12702 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12703
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012704show map [<map>]
12705 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12706 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12707
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012708show sess
12709 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012710 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12711 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12712
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012713show sess <id>
12714 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12715 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12716 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12717 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12718 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012719 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12720 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12721 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012722
12723show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12724 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12725 possible to dump only selected items :
12726 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12727 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12728 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12729 for example:
12730 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12731 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12732 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12733
12734 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012735 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12736 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012737 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12738 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12739 Nbproc: 1
12740 Process_num: 1
12741 (...)
12742
12743 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12744 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12745 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12746 (...)
12747 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12748
12749 $
12750
12751 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12752 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12753 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12754 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012755 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012756
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012757show table
12758 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12759 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12760 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12761 entries currently in use.
12762
12763 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012764 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012765 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12766 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012767
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012768show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012769 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12770 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12771 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012772 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12773
12774 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12775 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12776 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12777 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12778 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12779
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012780 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12781 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12782 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12783 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12784 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12785 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12786
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012787
12788 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012789 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12790 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012791
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012792 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012793 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012794 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012795 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12796 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12797 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12798 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012799
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012800 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012801 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012802 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12803 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012804
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012805 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12806 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012807 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012808 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12809 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012810
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012811 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12812 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012813 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012814 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12815 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12816
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012817 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12818 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12819 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12820 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12821 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12822
12823 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12824 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12825 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012826 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12827 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012828 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12829 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012830
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012831shutdown frontend <frontend>
12832 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12833 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12834 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12835 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12836 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12837 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12838 once it is terminated.
12839
12840 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12841 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12842
12843 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12844 level "admin".
12845
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012846shutdown session <id>
12847 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12848 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12849 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12850 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12851 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12852 flag in the logs.
12853
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012854shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12855 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12856 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12857 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12858 'K' flag in the logs.
12859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012860/*
12861 * Local variables:
12862 * fill-column: 79
12863 * End:
12864 */